blob: d1322233132347cc5b107ec8b7a4e83e17d0e682 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaub3066502017-11-26 19:50:17 +01005 version 1.9
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau72e92272018-12-08 16:20:55 +01007 2018/12/08
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100903 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100905 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
906 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
907 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
908
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100909 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
910 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
911 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
912 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200915 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
916 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
917 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
918 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
919 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
920 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200922 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100924log-send-hostname [<string>]
925 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
926 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
927 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
928 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
929 the logs.
930
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931log-tag <string>
932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
933 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
934 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100935 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100937lua-load <file>
938 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
939 used multiple times.
940
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100941master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200942 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
943 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
944 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200946 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
947 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
949 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
950 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
951 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
952 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956nbproc <number>
957 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
958 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
959 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
960 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
961 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
962
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200963nbthread <number>
964 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
965 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
966 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
967 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
968 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
969
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
973 starting the process. See also "daemon".
974
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100975presetenv <name> <value>
976 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
977 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
978 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
979 and "unsetenv".
980
981resetenv [<name> ...]
982 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
983 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
984 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
985 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
986 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
987 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
988 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
989 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
990
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100991stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200992 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
993 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
994 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
995 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
996 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
997 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100998 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100999 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1000 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1001 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1002 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001003
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001004server-state-base <directory>
1005 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001006 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1007 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001008
1009server-state-file <file>
1010 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1011 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1012 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1013 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1014 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1015 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1016 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1017 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001018 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1019 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001020
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001021setenv <name> <value>
1022 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1023 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1024 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1025 and "unsetenv".
1026
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001027ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1029 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001030 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 for all
1031 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
1032 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance
1033 a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). For
1034 TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites"
1035 keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1036
1037ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1039 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1040 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1041 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1042 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1043 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites", and can
1044 be for instance a string such as
1045 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
1046 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
1047 the "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
1048 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001049
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001050ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1052 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1053 keyword to see available options.
1054
1055 Example:
1056 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001057 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001058
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001059ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1061 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001062 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 with the server,
1063 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
1064 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration,
1065 please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the
1066 "server" keyword for more information.
1067
1068ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1069 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1070 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1071 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1072 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1073 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1074 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration for
1075 TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword.
1076 Please check the "server" keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001077
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001078ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1080 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1081 keyword to see available options.
1082
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001083ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1085 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1086 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001087 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001088 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001089 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1090 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1091 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1092 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001093 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1094 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1095 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1096
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001097ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1098 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1099 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1100 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1101
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001102stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1103 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1104 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1105 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001106 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001107 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001108
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001109 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1110 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1111 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001112
1113stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1114 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1115 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001116 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001117
1118stats maxconn <connections>
1119 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1120 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122uid <number>
1123 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1124 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1125 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1126 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1127
1128ulimit-n <number>
1129 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1130 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1131 option.
1132
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001133unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1134 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1135
1136 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1137 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1138 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1139 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1140 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1141 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1142 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1143 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1144 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1145 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1146
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001147unsetenv [<name> ...]
1148 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1149 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1150 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1151 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1152 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1153 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1154 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1155
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001156user <user name>
1157 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1158 See also "uid" and "group".
1159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001160node <name>
1161 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1162
1163 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1164 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1165 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1166 traffic.
1167
1168description <text>
1169 Add a text that describes the instance.
1170
1171 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1172 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1173 "<" and ">" characters.
1174
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100117551degrees-data-file <file path>
1176 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001178
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001179 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001180 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1181
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000118251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001183 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1184 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1185 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1186
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001187 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001188 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1189
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200119051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001191 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1192 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1193
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001194 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1195 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1196
119751degrees-cache-size <number>
1198 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1199 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1200 By default, this cache is disabled.
1201
1202 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001203 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1204
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001205wurfl-data-file <file path>
1206 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1207 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1208
1209 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1210 with USE_WURFL=1.
1211
1212wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1213 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1214 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1215 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1216
1217 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1218
1219 Valid WURFL properties are:
1220 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1221
1222 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1223 device.
1224
1225 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1226 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1227
1228 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1229 particular web request.
1230
1231 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1232 used Libwurfl API version.
1233
1234 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1235 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1236 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1237
1238 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1239 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1240
1241 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1242 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1243
1244 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1245
1246 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1247
1248 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1249 with USE_WURFL=1.
1250
1251wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1252 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1253 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1254
1255 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1256 with USE_WURFL=1.
1257
1258wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1259 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1260 thus before the chroot.
1261
1262 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1263 with USE_WURFL=1.
1264
1265wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1266 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1267 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001268 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001269 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001270 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001271 mode is enabled by default.
1272
1273 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1274 with USE_WURFL=1.
1275
1276wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1277 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1278 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1279 - "0" : no cache is used.
1280 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1281 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1282 the highest performing option.
1283
1284 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1285 with USE_WURFL=1.
1286
1287wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1288 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1289 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1290
1291 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1292 with USE_WURFL=1.
1293
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012953.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001296-----------------------
1297
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001298busy-polling
1299 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1300 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1301 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1302 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1303 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1304 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1305 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1306 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1307 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1308 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1309 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1310 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1311 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1312 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1313 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1314 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1315 "poll" pollers.
1316
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001317max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1318 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1319 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1320 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1321 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1322 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1323 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1324 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1325 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1326
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327maxconn <number>
1328 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1329 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1330 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001331 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1332 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1333 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1334 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001335 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1336 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1337 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1338 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1339 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001340
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001341maxconnrate <number>
1342 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1343 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1344 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1345 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1346 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1347 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1348 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1349 fairness.
1350
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001351maxcomprate <number>
1352 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001353 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001354 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1355 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1356 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001357 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001358 default value.
1359
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001360maxcompcpuusage <number>
1361 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1362 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1363 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1364 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1365 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1366 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1367 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1368 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1369
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001370maxpipes <number>
1371 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1372 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1373 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1374 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1375 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1376 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1377
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001378maxsessrate <number>
1379 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1380 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1381 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1382 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1383 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1384 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1385 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1386 fairness.
1387
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001388maxsslconn <number>
1389 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1390 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1391 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1392 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1393 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1394 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1395 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001396 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1397 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1398 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1399 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1400 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1401 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1402 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001403
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001404maxsslrate <number>
1405 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1406 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1407 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1408 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1409 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1410 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1411 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1412 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1413 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1414 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1415
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001416maxzlibmem <number>
1417 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1418 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1419 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001420 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1421 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1422 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1423
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001424noepoll
1425 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1426 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001427 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428
1429nokqueue
1430 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1431 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1432 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1433
1434nopoll
1435 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1436 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001438 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001440nosplice
1441 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001442 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001443 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001444 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001445 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1446 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1447 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1448 "option splice-response".
1449
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001450nogetaddrinfo
1451 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1452 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1453
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001454noreuseport
1455 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1456 command line argument "-dR".
1457
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001458profiling.tasks { on | off }
1459 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1460 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1461 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1462 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1463 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1464 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1465 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1466 CLI.
1467
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001468spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001469 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1470 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1471 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1472 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1473 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1474 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001476ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001477 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001478 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001479 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1480 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1481 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1482 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1483 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1485 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001486 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1487 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1488 openssl configuration file uses:
1489 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1490
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001491ssl-mode-async
1492 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001493 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001494 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1495 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1496 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1497 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1498 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001499
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001500tune.buffers.limit <number>
1501 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1502 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1503 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1504 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1505 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001507 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1508 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1509 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1510 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1511 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1512 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1513 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1514 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1515 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1516
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001517tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1518 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1519 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1520 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1521 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1522
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001523tune.bufsize <number>
1524 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1525 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1526 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1527 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1528 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1529 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1530 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001531 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1532 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1533 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001534 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001535 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1536 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1537 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001538
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001539tune.chksize <number>
1540 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1541 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1542 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1543 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1544 checks whenever possible.
1545
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001546tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1547 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1548 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1549 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1550 this value. The default value is 1.
1551
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001552tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1553 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1554 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1555 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1556 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1557 change it.
1558
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001559tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1560 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001561 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1562 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001563 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1564 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1565 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1566 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1567 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1568
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001569tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1570 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1571 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1572 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1573 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1574 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1575 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1576 recommended not to change this value.
1577
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001578tune.http.cookielen <number>
1579 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1580 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1581 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1582 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1583 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1584 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1585 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1586 to change this value.
1587
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001588tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001589 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1590 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001591 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001592 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001593 configuration directives too.
1594 The default value is 1024.
1595
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001596tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1597 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1598 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1599 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1600 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1601 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1602 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001603 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1604 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1605 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001606
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001607tune.idletimer <timeout>
1608 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1609 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1610 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1611 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1612 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1613 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001614 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001615 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1616 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1617
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001618tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1619 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001620 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001621 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1622 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001623 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001624 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1625 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1626
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001627tune.lua.maxmem
1628 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1629 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1630 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1631 memory.
1632
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001633tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1634 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001635 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1636 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001637 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001638
1639tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1640 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1641 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1642 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1643 check servers.
1644
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001645tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1646 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1647 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1648 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001649 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001650
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001651tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001652 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1653 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1654 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1655 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1656 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1657 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1658 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1659 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1660 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1661 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001662
1663tune.maxpollevents <number>
1664 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1665 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1666 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1667 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1668 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1669
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001670tune.maxrewrite <number>
1671 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1672 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1673 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1674 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1675 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1676 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1677 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1678 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1679 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1680 bufsize.
1681
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001682tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1683 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1684 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1685 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1686 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1687 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1688 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1689 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1690 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1691 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1692 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1693 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1694 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1695 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1696 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1697 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1698 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1699 setting this parameter to 0.
1700
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001701tune.pipesize <number>
1702 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1703 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1704 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1705 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1706 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1707 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1708
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001709tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1710tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1711 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1712 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1713 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1714 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001715 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001716 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1717 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1718
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001719tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001720 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001721 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1722 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1723 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1724 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1725
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001726tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1727 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1728 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1729 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1730
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001731tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1732tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1733 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1734 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1735 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1736 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001737 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001738 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1739 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1740 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1741 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1742 notifying haproxy again.
1743
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001744tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001745 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1746 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1747 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001748 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001749 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001750 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001751 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1752 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1753 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001754 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1755 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001756
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001757tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001758 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001759 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1760 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1761 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1762 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1763 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1764
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001765tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1766 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001767 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001768 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1769 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1770 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1771 being used for too long.
1772
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001773tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1774 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1775 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1776 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1777 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1778 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1779 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1780 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1781 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1782 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1783 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001784 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001785 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001786
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001787tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1788 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1789 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1790 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1791 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1792 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1793 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1794 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001795 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1796 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001797
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001798tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1799 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1800 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1801 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1802 1000 entries.
1803
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001804tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1805 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1806 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1807 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1808
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001809tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001810tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001811tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1812tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1813tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001814 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1815 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1816 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1817 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1818 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1819 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1820 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1821 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001822
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001823 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1824 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1825 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1826 all available space is consumed.
1827 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1828 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1829 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001830
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001831tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1832 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001833 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001834 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001835 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001836 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1837
1838tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1839 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1840 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001841 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1842 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018443.3. Debugging
1845--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001846
1847debug
1848 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1849 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1850 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1851 system startup.
1852
1853quiet
1854 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1855 line argument "-q".
1856
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018583.4. Userlists
1859--------------
1860It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1861http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1862it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1863
1864userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001865 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001866 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1867
1868group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001869 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001870 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1871 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1872
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001873user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1874 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001875 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1876 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001877 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1878 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1879 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1880 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001881
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001882 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1883 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1884 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1885 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1886 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1887 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1888 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1889 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1890 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001891
1892 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001893 userlist L1
1894 group G1 users tiger,scott
1895 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001896
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001897 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1898 user scott insecure-password elgato
1899 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001900
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001901 userlist L2
1902 group G1
1903 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001905 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1906 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1907 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001908
1909 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001910
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001911
19123.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001913----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001914It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1915several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1916instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1917values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1918automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1919In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1920using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1921tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1922reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1923Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1924that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1925each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001926
1927peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001928 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001929 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1930
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001931disabled
1932 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1933 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1934 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1935
1936enable
1937 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1938
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001939peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1940 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1941 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1942 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1943 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1944 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1945 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1946
1947 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1948 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1949
1950 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1951 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1952 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1953 across all peers.
1954
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001955 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1956 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001957
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001958 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001959 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001960 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1961 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1962 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001963
1964 backend mybackend
1965 mode tcp
1966 balance roundrobin
1967 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1968 stick on src
1969
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001970 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1971 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001972
1973
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090019743.6. Mailers
1975------------
1976It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1977If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1978in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1979
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001980mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001981 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1982 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1983
1984mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1985 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1986
1987 Example:
1988 mailers mymailers
1989 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1990 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1991
1992 backend mybackend
1993 mode tcp
1994 balance roundrobin
1995
1996 email-alert mailers mymailers
1997 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1998 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1999
2000 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2001 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2002
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002003timeout mail <time>
2004 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2005 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2006 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2007 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2008
2009 Example:
2010 mailers mymailers
2011 timeout mail 20s
2012 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020144. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002015----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002017Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002018 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002019 - frontend <name>
2020 - backend <name>
2021 - listen <name>
2022
2023A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2024its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2025section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002027
2028A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2029connections.
2030
2031A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2032to forward incoming connections.
2033
2034A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2035parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2036
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002037All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2038'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2039case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2040
2041Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2042logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2043proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2044However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2045name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2046
2047Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2048and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002049bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002050protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2051modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2052arbitrary criteria.
2053
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002054In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2055a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002056the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002057
2058 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2059 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2060 between responses and new requests.
2061
2062 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2063 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2064 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002065 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2066 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002067
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002068 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2069 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2070 client-facing connection remains open.
2071
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002072 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2073 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002074
2075The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2076frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2077following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002078weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002079
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002080 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002081
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002082 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2083 ----+-----+-----+----
2084 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2085 ----+-----+-----+----
2086 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2087 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2088 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2089 ----+-----+-----+----
2090 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002091
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020944.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2095--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002097The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2098limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2099they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2100limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002101marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002102option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002103and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2104with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2105specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002106
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002107
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002108 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2109------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2110acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002111appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002112backlog X X X -
2113balance X - X X
2114bind - X X -
2115bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002116block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002117capture cookie - X X -
2118capture request header - X X -
2119capture response header - X X -
2120clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002121compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002122contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2123cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002124declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002125default-server X - X X
2126default_backend X X X -
2127description - X X X
2128disabled X X X X
2129dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002130email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002131email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002132email-alert mailers X X X X
2133email-alert myhostname X X X X
2134email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002135enabled X X X X
2136errorfile X X X X
2137errorloc X X X X
2138errorloc302 X X X X
2139-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2140errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002141force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002142filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002143fullconn X - X X
2144grace X X X X
2145hash-type X - X X
2146http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002147http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002148http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002149http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002150http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002151http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002152http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002153id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002154ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002155load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002156log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002157log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002158log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002159log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002160max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002161maxconn X X X -
2162mode X X X X
2163monitor fail - X X -
2164monitor-net X X X -
2165monitor-uri X X X -
2166option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2167option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2168option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2169option allbackups (*) X - X X
2170option checkcache (*) X - X X
2171option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2172option contstats (*) X X X -
2173option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2174option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002175option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002176-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2177option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002178option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002179option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002180option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002181option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002182option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002183option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002184option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002185option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002186option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002187option httpchk X - X X
2188option httpclose (*) X X X X
2189option httplog X X X X
2190option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002191option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002192option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002193option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002194option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2195option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2196option logasap (*) X X X -
2197option mysql-check X - X X
2198option nolinger (*) X X X X
2199option originalto X X X X
2200option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002201option pgsql-check X - X X
2202option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002203option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002204option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002205option smtpchk X - X X
2206option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2207option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2208option splice-request (*) X X X X
2209option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002210option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002211option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2212option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2213-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002214option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002215option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2216option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2217option tcpka X X X X
2218option tcplog X X X X
2219option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002220external-check command X - X X
2221external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002222persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2223rate-limit sessions X X X -
2224redirect - X X X
2225redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2226redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2227reqadd - X X X
2228reqallow - X X X
2229reqdel - X X X
2230reqdeny - X X X
2231reqiallow - X X X
2232reqidel - X X X
2233reqideny - X X X
2234reqipass - X X X
2235reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002236reqitarpit - X X X
2237reqpass - X X X
2238reqrep - X X X
2239-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002240reqtarpit - X X X
2241retries X - X X
2242rspadd - X X X
2243rspdel - X X X
2244rspdeny - X X X
2245rspidel - X X X
2246rspideny - X X X
2247rspirep - X X X
2248rsprep - X X X
2249server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002250server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002251server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002252source X - X X
2253srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002254stats admin - X X X
2255stats auth X X X X
2256stats enable X X X X
2257stats hide-version X X X X
2258stats http-request - X X X
2259stats realm X X X X
2260stats refresh X X X X
2261stats scope X X X X
2262stats show-desc X X X X
2263stats show-legends X X X X
2264stats show-node X X X X
2265stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002266-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2267stick match - - X X
2268stick on - - X X
2269stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002270stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002271stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002272tcp-check connect - - X X
2273tcp-check expect - - X X
2274tcp-check send - - X X
2275tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002276tcp-request connection - X X -
2277tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002278tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002279tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002280tcp-response content - - X X
2281tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002282timeout check X - X X
2283timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002284timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002285timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2286timeout connect X - X X
2287timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2288timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2289timeout http-request X X X X
2290timeout queue X - X X
2291timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002292timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002293timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2294timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002295timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002296transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002297unique-id-format X X X -
2298unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002299use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002300use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002301------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2302 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023054.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2306---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307
2308This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2309
2310
2311acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2312 Declare or complete an access list.
2313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2314 no | yes | yes | yes
2315 Example:
2316 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2317 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2318 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002320 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321
2322
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002323appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2324 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002325 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2327 no | no | yes | yes
2328 Arguments :
2329 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2330 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2331
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002332 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333 checked in each cookie value.
2334
2335 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2336 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2337 milliseconds.
2338
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002339 request-learn
2340 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2341 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2342 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2343 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2344 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2345 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2346
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002347 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2348 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2349 data following this prefix.
2350
2351 Example :
2352 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002354 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2355 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002356
2357 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2358 2 modes are currently supported :
2359 - path-parameters :
2360 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2361 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2362 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2363 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2364 - query-string :
2365 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2366 query string.
2367
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002368 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2369 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2370 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002371
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002372 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2373 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374
2375
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002376backlog <conns>
2377 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2379 yes | yes | yes | no
2380 Arguments :
2381 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2382 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002383 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002384
2385 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2386 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2387 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2388 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2389 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2390 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2391 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2392 backlog parameter.
2393
2394 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2395 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2396 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2397
2398 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2399
2400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002402balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002403 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2405 yes | no | yes | yes
2406 Arguments :
2407 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2408 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2409 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2410 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2411
2412 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2413 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2414 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2415 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002416 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002417 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002418 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2419 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2420 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2421 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2422 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2423 it, so that you don't worry.
2424
2425 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2426 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2427 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2428 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2429 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2430 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2431 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2432 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002434 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2435 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2436 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2437 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2438 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2439 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2440 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2441 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2442
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002443 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002444 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002445 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2446 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002447 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002448 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2449 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2450 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2451 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2452 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002453 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2454 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2455 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2456 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2457 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2458 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002460 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2461 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2462 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2463 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2464 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2465 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2466 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2467 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002468 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002469 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002470 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2471 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2472 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002474 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2475 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2476 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2477 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2478 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2479 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2480 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2481 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2482 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2483 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2484 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2485 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002486
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002487 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002488 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2489 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2490 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2491 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2492 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2493 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2494 URIs start with a leading "/".
2495
2496 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2497 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2498 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2499 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2500
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002501 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002502 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2503
2504 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002505 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2506 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002507 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2508 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2509 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2510 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002511 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002512 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2513 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002514
2515 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2516 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2517 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2518 server will receive the request.
2519
2520 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2521 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2522 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2523 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2524 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002525 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2526 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2527 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002528
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002529 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2530 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2531 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2532 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2533 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002535 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002536 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2537 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2538 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2539
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002540 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2541 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2542 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2543
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002544 random A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
2545 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2546 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2547 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2548 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
2549 or removed. The hash-balance-factor directive can be used to
2550 further improve fairness of the load balancing, especially
2551 in situations where servers show highly variable response
2552 times.
2553
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002554 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002555 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002556 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2557 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2558 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2559 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2560 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2561 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002562 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002563 used instead.
2564
2565 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2566 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2567 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2568 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2569
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002570 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2571 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2572 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2573
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002574 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002575
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002576 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002577 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2578 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002579
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002580 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2581 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2582 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002583
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002584 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2585 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2586 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2587 NTLM relies on.
2588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002589 Examples :
2590 balance roundrobin
2591 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002592 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002593 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2594 balance hdr(host)
2595 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002596
2597 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2598 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002600 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002601 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2602 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2603 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2604 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2605
2606 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2607 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2608 defaults to 16 kB.
2609
2610 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2611 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2612
2613 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2614 Round Robin.
2615
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002616 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002617 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2618 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2619 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2620
2621 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2622
2623 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002624 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002625 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2626 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2627 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002629 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002630
2631
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002632bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2633bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2636 no | yes | yes | no
2637 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002638 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2639 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2640 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2641 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002642 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002643 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2644 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2645 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2646 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2647 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2648 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2649 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002650 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2651 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2652 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2653 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2654 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2655 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2656 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002657 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2658 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2659 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002660 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2661 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2662 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2663 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002664 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2665 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2666 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002667
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002668 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2669 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002670 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2671 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2672 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002673 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2674 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2675 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2676 the range.
2677
2678 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2679 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2680 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2681 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2682 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2683 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2684 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002685 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002686 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002687
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002688 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002689 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002690 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2691 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2692 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2693 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2694 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2695 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2696
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002697 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2698 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2699 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2700 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002701
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2703 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2704 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2705 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2706 in a frontend.
2707
2708 Example :
2709 listen http_proxy
2710 bind :80,:443
2711 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002712 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002713
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002714 listen http_https_proxy
2715 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002716 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002717
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002718 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2719 bind ipv6@:80
2720 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2721 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2722
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002723 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002724 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002725
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002726 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2727 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2728 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2729 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2730 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2731
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002732 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002733 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734
2735
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002736bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002737 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2739 yes | yes | yes | yes
2740 Arguments :
2741 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2742 may be used to override a default value.
2743
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002744 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002745 option may be combined with other numbers.
2746
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002747 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002748 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2749 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2750 missing from all processes.
2751
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002752 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002753 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002754 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2755 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2756 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2757 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2758 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002759 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002760
2761 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2762 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2763 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2764 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2765 and 'even' instances.
2766
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002767 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2768 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2769 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2770 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002771
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002772 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2773 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2774
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002775 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2776 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2777 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2778
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002779 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2780 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2781
2782 Example :
2783 listen app_ip1
2784 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002785 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002786
2787 listen app_ip2
2788 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002789 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002790
2791 listen management
2792 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002793 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002794
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002795 listen management
2796 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2797 bind-process 1-4
2798
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002799 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002800
2801
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002802block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002803 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2805 no | yes | yes | yes
2806
2807 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2808 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002809 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002810 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002812 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2813 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2814 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002816 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2817 "http-request deny" instead.
2818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819 Example:
2820 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2821 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2822 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002823 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2824 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2825 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002827 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2828 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2829 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830
2831capture cookie <name> len <length>
2832 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2834 no | yes | yes | no
2835 Arguments :
2836 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2837 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2838 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2839 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002840 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841
2842 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2843 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2844 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2845 right if it exceeds <length>.
2846
2847 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2848 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2849 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2850 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2851
2852 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2853 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2854 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2855
2856 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2857 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2858 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002859 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2860 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2861 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002862
2863 Example:
2864 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2865
2866 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002867 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002868
2869
2870capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002871 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2873 no | yes | yes | no
2874 Arguments :
2875 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002876 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002877 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2878 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2879 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2880
2881 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2882 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2883 it exceeds <length>.
2884
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002885 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2887 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002888 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2889 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2890 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2891 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002892 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002893 environments to find where the request came from.
2894
2895 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2896 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2897 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2898 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002899
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002900 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2901 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2902 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2903 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2904 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002905
2906 Example:
2907 capture request header Host len 15
2908 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002909 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002911 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912 about logging.
2913
2914
2915capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002916 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2918 no | yes | yes | no
2919 Arguments :
2920 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002921 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002922 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2923 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2924 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2925
2926 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2927 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2928 it exceeds <length>.
2929
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002930 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2932 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2933 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002934 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2935 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2936 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2937 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002939 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2940 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2941 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2942 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2943 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002944
2945 Example:
2946 capture response header Content-length len 9
2947 capture response header Location len 15
2948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002949 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002950 about logging.
2951
2952
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002953clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2956 yes | yes | yes | no
2957 Arguments :
2958 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2959 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2960 as explained at the top of this document.
2961
2962 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2963 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2964 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2965 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2966 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2967 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2968 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2969 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002970 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002971 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002972 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002973
2974 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2975 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2976 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2977 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2978 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2979 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2980
2981 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2982 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2983
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002984 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2985 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002987compression algo <algorithm> ...
2988compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002989compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002990 Enable HTTP compression.
2991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2992 yes | yes | yes | yes
2993 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002994 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2995 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2996 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2997
2998 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002999 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3000 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3001 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003002
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003003 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003004 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003005
3006 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3007 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3008 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3009 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3010 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003011 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003012
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003013 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3014 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3015 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3016 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3017 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3018 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3019 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003020 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003021
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003022 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003023 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003024 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3025 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3026 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3027 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3028 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003029
3030 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3031 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3032 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3033 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3034 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003035 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3036 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3037 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3038 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3039 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003040 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3041 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003042
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003043 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003044 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3045 "Accept-Encoding" header
3046 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01003047 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01003048 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
3049 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003050 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3051 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3052 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3053 "multipart"
3054 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3055 header
3056 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3057 and later
3058 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3059 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003060
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003061 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
3062 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003063
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003064 Examples :
3065 compression algo gzip
3066 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003068
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003069contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3072 yes | no | yes | yes
3073 Arguments :
3074 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3075 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3076 as explained at the top of this document.
3077
3078 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003079 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003080 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003081 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3083 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3084 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3085
3086 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3087 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3088 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3089 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3090 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3091 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3092
3093 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3094 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3095 instead.
3096
3097 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3098 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3099
3100
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003101cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003102 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3103 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003104 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3107 yes | no | yes | yes
3108 Arguments :
3109 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3110 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3111 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3112 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3113 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3114 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003115 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3117 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3118
3119 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3120 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3121 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3122 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3123 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3124 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003125 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3126 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003127 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003128 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3129 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130
3131 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003132 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003133
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003134 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003135 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3136 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003137 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003138 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3139 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3140 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3141 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3142 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3143 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3144 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145
3146 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3147 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3148 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3149 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3150 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3151 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3152 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3153 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3154 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003155 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003156 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3157 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3158 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003159
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003160 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3161 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3162 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003163 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3164 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3165 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3166 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003167 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3168 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3169 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170
3171 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3172 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3173 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3174 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3175 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3176 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3177 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3178 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3179 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3180
3181 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3182 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3183 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3184 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3185 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3186 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3187 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3188 persistence cookie in the cache.
3189 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3190
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003191 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3192 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3193 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3194 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3195 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003196 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003197 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3198 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3199 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3200 they logout.
3201
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003202 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3203 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3204 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3205 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3206
3207 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3208 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3209 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3210 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3211 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3212 this attribute.
3213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003214 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003215 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003216 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3217 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3218 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3219 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3220 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3221 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003222
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003223 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3224 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3225 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3226 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3227 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3228 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3229 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3230 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003231 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003232 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3233 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3234 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3235 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3236 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3237 the site.
3238
3239 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3240 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3241 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3242 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3243 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3244 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3245 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3246 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3247 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3248 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3249 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3250 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3251 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003252 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003253 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3254 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3255
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003256 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3257 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3258 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3259 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3260 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3261 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003263 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3264 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3265 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3266 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003268 Examples :
3269 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3270 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3271 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003272 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003274 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003276
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003277declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3278 Declares a capture slot.
3279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3280 no | yes | yes | no
3281 Arguments:
3282 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3283
3284 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3285 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3286 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3287 for use in the response.
3288
3289 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003290 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003291 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3292
3293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003294default-server [param*]
3295 Change default options for a server in a backend
3296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3297 yes | no | yes | yes
3298 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003299 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3300 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3301 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3302 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003303
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003304 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003305 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3306
3307 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003308
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003309
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003310default_backend <backend>
3311 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3313 yes | yes | yes | no
3314 Arguments :
3315 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3316
3317 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3318 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3319 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3320 will catch all undetermined requests.
3321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003322 Example :
3323
3324 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3325 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3326 default_backend dynamic
3327
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003328 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003329
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003330
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003331description <string>
3332 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3334 no | yes | yes | yes
3335 Arguments : string
3336
3337 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3338 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3339 it describes.
3340 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3341
3342
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003343disabled
3344 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 yes | yes | yes | yes
3347 Arguments : none
3348
3349 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3350 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3351 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3352 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3353 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3354 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3355 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3356
3357 See also : "enabled"
3358
3359
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003360dispatch <address>:<port>
3361 Set a default server address
3362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3363 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003364 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003365
3366 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3367 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3368 during start-up.
3369
3370 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3371 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3372 possible with normal servers.
3373
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003374 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003375 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3376 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3377 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3378 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3379
3380 See also : "server"
3381
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003382
3383dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3384 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | no | yes | yes
3387 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3388
3389 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003390 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003391 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3392 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003393 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003394 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003396enabled
3397 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3399 yes | yes | yes | yes
3400 Arguments : none
3401
3402 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3403 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3404
3405 See also : "disabled"
3406
3407
3408errorfile <code> <file>
3409 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3411 yes | yes | yes | yes
3412 Arguments :
3413 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003414 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3415 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003416
3417 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003418 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003420 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3421 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003422
3423 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3424 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3425 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3426
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003427 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3428
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003429 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3430 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3431 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3432 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3433
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003434 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3435 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003436 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003437 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3438 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3439 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3440
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003441 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3442 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3443 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003444 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003445 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3446
3447 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3448
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003449 Example :
3450 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003451 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003452 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3453 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3454
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003455
3456errorloc <code> <url>
3457errorloc302 <code> <url>
3458 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3460 yes | yes | yes | yes
3461 Arguments :
3462 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003463 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3464 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003465
3466 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3467 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3468 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3469 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003470 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003471
3472 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3473 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3474 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3475
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003476 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3477
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003478 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3479 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3480 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3481 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003482 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003483 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3484 request.
3485
3486 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3487
3488
3489errorloc303 <code> <url>
3490 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3492 yes | yes | yes | yes
3493 Arguments :
3494 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003495 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3496 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003497
3498 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3499 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3500 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3501 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003502 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003503
3504 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3505 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3506 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3507
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003508 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3509
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003510 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3511 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3512 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3513 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003514 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003515
3516 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3517
3518
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003519email-alert from <emailaddr>
3520 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003521 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003522 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3523 yes | yes | yes | yes
3524
3525 Arguments :
3526
3527 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3528
3529 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3530 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3531
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003532 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003533 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3534 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003535
3536
3537email-alert level <level>
3538 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3539 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3540 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3541 yes | yes | yes | yes
3542
3543 Arguments :
3544
3545 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3546 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3547 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3548
3549 By default level is alert
3550
3551 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3552 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3553 for the proxy.
3554
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003555 Alerts are sent when :
3556
3557 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3558 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3559 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3560 is notice or lower
3561 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3562 and a health check status update occurs
3563
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003564 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3565 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003566 section 3.6 about mailers.
3567
3568
3569email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3570 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3572 yes | yes | yes | yes
3573
3574 Arguments :
3575
3576 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3577
3578 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3579 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3580
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003581 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3582 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003583
3584
3585email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3586 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3587 mailers.
3588 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3589 yes | yes | yes | yes
3590
3591 Arguments :
3592
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003593 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003594
3595 By default the systems hostname is used.
3596
3597 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3598 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3599 for the proxy.
3600
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003601 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3602 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003603
3604
3605email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003606 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003607 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3608 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3609 yes | yes | yes | yes
3610
3611 Arguments :
3612
3613 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3614
3615 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3616 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3617
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003618 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003619 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3620
3621
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003622force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3623 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3624 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003625 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003626
3627 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3628 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3629 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3630 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3631 marked down for maintenance operations.
3632
3633 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3634 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3635 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3636 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3637 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3638 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3639 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3640 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3641 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3642
3643 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3644 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3645 is used.
3646
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003647 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003648 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003649
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003650
3651filter <name> [param*]
3652 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 no | yes | yes | yes
3655 Arguments :
3656 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3657 referenced in section 9.
3658
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003659 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003660 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003661 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3662 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003663
3664 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3665 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3666
3667 Example:
3668 listen
3669 bind *:80
3670
3671 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3672 filter compression
3673 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3674
3675 compression algo gzip
3676 compression offload
3677
3678 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3679
3680 See also : section 9.
3681
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003682
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003683fullconn <conns>
3684 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3686 yes | no | yes | yes
3687 Arguments :
3688 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3689 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3690
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003691 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003692 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003693 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003694 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3695 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3696 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3697 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3698 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003699 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003700
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003701 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3702 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003703 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3704 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3705 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003706
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003707 Example :
3708 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3709 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3710 # connections.
3711 backend dynamic
3712 fullconn 10000
3713 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3714 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3715
3716 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3717
3718
3719grace <time>
3720 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003722 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003723 Arguments :
3724 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3725 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3726 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3727
3728 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3729 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003730 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003731 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3732
3733 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3734 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3735 simplify it.
3736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003737
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003738hash-balance-factor <factor>
3739 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3741 yes | no | no | yes
3742 Arguments :
3743 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3744 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3745 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3746
3747 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3748 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3749 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3750 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3751 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3752 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3753 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3754
3755 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3756 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3757 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3758 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3759 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3760
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003761 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3762 consistent hashing mechanism.
3763
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003764 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3765
3766
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003767hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003768 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3770 yes | no | yes | yes
3771 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003772 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3773 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003774
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003775 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3776 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3777 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3778 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3779 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3780 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3781 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3782 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3783 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3784 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003785
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003786 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3787 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3788 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3789 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3790 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3791 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3792 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3793 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3794 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3795 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3796 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3797 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3798 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003799 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3800 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003801
3802 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3803
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003804 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003805 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3806 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3807 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003808 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3809 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3810 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003811
3812 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3813 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003814 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3815 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3816 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3817 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3818
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003819 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3820 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3821 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3822 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3823 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3824 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3825 parameter.
3826
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003827 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3828 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3829 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3830 used on strings.
3831
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003832 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3833
3834 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3835 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3836 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3837 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3838 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3839 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3840 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3841 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3842 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3843 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3844 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3845 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003846
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003847 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3848 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3849 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003850
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003851 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003852
3853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003854http-check disable-on-404
3855 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003857 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003858 Arguments : none
3859
3860 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3861 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3862 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3863 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3864 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3865 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3866 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3867 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003868 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3869 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3870 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3871
3872 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3873
3874
3875http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003876 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003878 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003879 Arguments :
3880 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3881 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003882 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003883 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3884 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3885 details on the supported keywords.
3886
3887 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3888 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3889 with the usual backslash ('\').
3890
3891 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3892 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3893 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3894 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3895 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3896
3897 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003898 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003899 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3900 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3901 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3902
3903 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003904 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003905 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3906 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3907 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3908 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3909
3910 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003911 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003912 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3913 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3914 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3915 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3916 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003917 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003918 trace).
3919
3920 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003921 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003922 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3923 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3924 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3925 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3926 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003927 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003928
3929 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3930 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3931 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3932 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3933 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3934 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3935 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3936 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3937
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003938 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3939 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3940 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3941
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003942 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3943 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3944
3945 Examples :
3946 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003947 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003948
3949 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003950 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003951
3952 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003953 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003954
3955 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003956 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003957
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003958 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003959
3960
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003961http-check send-state
3962 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3964 yes | no | yes | yes
3965 Arguments : none
3966
3967 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3968 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3969 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3970 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3971 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3972
3973 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3974 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3975 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3976 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3977 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003978 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3979 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3980 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3981
3982 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3983 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3984 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3985
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003986 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3987 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3988 checked in multiple backends.
3989
3990 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3991 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3992
3993 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3994 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3995 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3996 one fails.
3997
3998 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3999 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4000 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4001
4002 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4003 server's queue.
4004
4005 Example of a header received by the application server :
4006 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4007 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4008
4009 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004011
4012http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004013 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4014
4015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4016 no | yes | yes | yes
4017
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004018 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4019 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4020 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4021 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4022 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004024 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4025 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004027 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004029 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4030 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4031 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4032 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004034 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4035 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4036 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4037 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004038
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004039 Example:
4040 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4041 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4042 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004044 http-request allow if nagios
4045 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4046 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4047 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004049 Example:
4050 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4051 acl add path /addacl
4052 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004054 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004056 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4057 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004059 Example:
4060 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4061 acl setmap path /setmap
4062 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004064 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004065
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004066 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4067 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004068
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004069 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4070 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004072http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004073
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004074 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4075 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4076 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4077 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4078 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4079 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4080 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4081 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004083http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004085 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4086 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4087 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4088 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4089 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4090 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4091 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4092 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004094http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004096 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4097 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004098
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004100http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004102 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4103 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4104 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4105 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4106 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004108 Example:
4109 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4110 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004112http-request cache-use [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004114 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004116http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4117 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004119 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4120 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4121 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4122 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4123 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4124 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4125 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4126 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4127 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004129 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4130 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4131 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4132 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4133 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4134 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004136http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004138 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4139 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4140 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4141 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4142 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4143 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004145http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004147 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004149http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004151 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4152 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4153 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4154 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4155 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4156 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004158http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4161 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4162 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4163 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4164 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004165
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004166http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4167
4168 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4169 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4170 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4171 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004172 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4173 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004174
4175 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004177http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004179 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4180 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4181 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4182 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4183 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004185http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004187 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4188 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4189 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4190 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004192http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4193 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004195 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4196 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4197 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4198 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4199 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4200 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4201 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4202 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204 Example:
4205 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004206
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004207 # applied to:
4208 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004210 # outputs:
4211 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004213 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004215http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4216 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004218 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4219 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4220 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4221 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004223 Example:
4224 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004226 # applied to:
4227 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004228
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004229 # outputs:
4230 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4233http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004235 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4236 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4237 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004239http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004241 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4242 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4243 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004245http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004247 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4248 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4249 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4250 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4251 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004253 Arguments:
4254 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4255 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004257 Example:
4258 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4259 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004261 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4262 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004264http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004266 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4267 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4268 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004270 Arguments:
4271 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4272 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004274 Example:
4275 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4276 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4279 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4280 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4285 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4286 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4287 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4288 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 Example:
4291 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4292 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4293 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4294 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4295 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4296 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4297 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4298 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4299 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004302
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004303 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4304 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4305 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4306 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4307 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4310 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004312 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4313 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4314 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4315 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4316 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4317 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4318 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4319 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4320 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4325 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4326 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4327 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4328 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4329 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4330 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004332http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004334 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4335 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4336 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4341 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4342 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4343 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4344 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4345 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4346 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4347 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004349http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4352 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4353 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4354 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4355 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4356 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004358 Example :
4359 # prepend the host name before the path
4360 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004364 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4365 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4366 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4367 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4368 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004370http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004372 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4373 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4374 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4375 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4376 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4377 values have higher priority.
4378 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4379 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4380 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4381 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4382 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4387 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4388 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4389 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4390 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4391 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4392 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004395
4396 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4398 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4401 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4402 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4403 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4404 privacy.
4405
4406 Arguments :
4407 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4408 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004409
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004410 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004411 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4412 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4413
4414 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4415 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4416
4417http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4418
4419 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4420 expression.
4421
4422 Arguments:
4423 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4424 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004425
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004426 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4428 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4429
4430 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4431 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4432 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4433
4434http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4435
4436 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4437 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4438 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4439 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4440 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4441 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4442 information from the request.
4443
4444 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4445
4446http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4447
4448 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4449 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4450 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4451 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4452 path and the query string.
4453 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4454
4455http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4456
4457 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4458 inline.
4459
4460 Arguments:
4461 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4462 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4463 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4464 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4465 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4466 (request and response)
4467 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4468 processing
4469 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4470 processing
4471 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4472 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4473 and '_'.
4474
4475 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4476 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004477
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004478 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004479 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004481http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4482 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004484 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4485 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4486 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4487 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4488 agent name must be used.
4489
4490 Arguments:
4491 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4492
4493 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4494 configuration.
4495
4496http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4497
4498 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4499 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4500 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4501 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4502 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4503 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4504 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4505 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4506 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4507 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4508 action.
4509 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4510 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4511 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4512 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4513 you fully understand how it works.
4514
4515http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4516
4517 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4518 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4519 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4520 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4521 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4522 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4523 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4524 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4525 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4526 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4527 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4528 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4529 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4530
4531http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4532http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4533http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4534
4535 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4536 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4537 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4538 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4539 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4540 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4541 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4542 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4543 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4544 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4545 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4546 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4547
4548 Arguments :
4549 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4550 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4551 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4552 select which table entry to update the counters.
4553
4554 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4555 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4556 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4557 that table until the session ends.
4558
4559 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4560 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4561 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4562 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4563 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4564 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4565 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4566 useful information.
4567
4568 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4569 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4570 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4571 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4572 checks that make use of it.
4573
4574http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4575
4576 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004577
4578 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004581http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004583 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4584 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4585 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004586
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004587
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004588http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004589 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4590
4591 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4592 no | yes | yes | yes
4593
4594 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4595 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4596 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4597 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4598 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4599 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4600
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004601 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4602 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004603
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004604 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004605
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004606 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4607 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4608 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4609 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004610
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004611 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4612 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4613 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4614 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004615
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004616 Example:
4617 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004618
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004619 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004620
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004621 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4622 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004623
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004624 Example:
4625 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004626
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004627 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004628
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004629 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4630 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004631
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004632 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4633 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004634
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004635http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004636
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004637 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4638 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4639 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4640 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4641 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4642 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4643 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4644 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004645
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004646http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004647
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004648 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4649 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4650 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4651 example, or to pass some internal information.
4652 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4653 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4654 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004655
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004656http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004657
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004658 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4659 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004660
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004661http-response cache-store [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004662
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004663 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004664
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004665http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004666
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004667 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4668 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4669 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4670 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4671 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4672 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4673 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004674
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004675 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4676 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4677 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4678 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4679 keyword.
4680 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4681 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004683http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004684
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004685 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4686 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4687 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4688 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4689 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4690 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004691
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004692http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004693
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004694 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004696http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004697
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004698 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4699 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4700 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4701 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4702 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4703 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004704
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004705http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004706
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004707 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4708 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004709
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004710http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004711
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004712 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4713 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4714 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4715 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4716 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4717 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004718
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004719http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4720 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004721
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004722 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4723 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4724 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4725 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4726 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4727 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4728 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4729 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004730
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004731 Example:
4732 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004733
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004734 # applied to:
4735 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004736
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004737 # outputs:
4738 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004740 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004741
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004742http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4743 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004744
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004745 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4746 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4747 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4748 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004749
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004750 Example:
4751 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004752
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004753 # applied to:
4754 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004755
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004756 # outputs:
4757 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004759http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4760http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004762 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4763 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4764 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004765
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004766http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004767
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004768 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4769 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4770 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004771
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004772http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004773
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004774 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4775 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4776 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4777 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4778 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004779
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004780 Arguments:
4781 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004782
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004783 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4784 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004785
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004786http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004787
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004788 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4789 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4790 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004791
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004792http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4793
4794 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4795 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4796 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4797 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4798 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4799
4800http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4801
4802 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4803 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4804 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4805 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4806 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4807 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4808 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4809 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4810 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4811
4812http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4813
4814 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4815 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4816 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4817 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4818 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4819 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4820 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4821
4822http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4823
4824 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4825 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4826 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4827 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4828 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4829 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4830 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4831 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4832
4833http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4834 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4835
4836 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4837 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4838 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4839 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004840
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004841 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004842 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4843 http-response set-status 431
4844 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4845 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004846
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004847http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004848
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004849 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4850 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4851 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4852 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4853 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4854 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4855 based on some information from the request.
4856
4857 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4858
4859http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4860
4861 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4862 inline.
4863
4864 Arguments:
4865 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4866 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4867 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4868 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4869 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4870 (request and response)
4871 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4872 processing
4873 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4874 processing
4875 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4876 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4877 and '_'.
4878
4879 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4880 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004881
4882 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004884
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004885http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004886
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004887 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4888 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4889 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4890 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4891 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4892 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4893 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4894 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4895 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4896 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4897 action.
4898 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4899 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4900 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4901 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4902 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004904http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4905http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4906http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004908 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4909 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4910 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4911 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4912 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4913 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4914
4915http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4916
4917 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4918 about <var-name>.
4919
4920 Example:
4921 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4922
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004923
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004924http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4925 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4926
4927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4928 yes | no | yes | yes
4929
4930 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4931 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4932 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4933 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4934 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004935 This directive allows to tune this behavior.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004936
4937 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4938
4939 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4940 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4941 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4942 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4943 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4944 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4945 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4946 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4947 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4948 not checking any request past the first one.
4949
4950 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4951 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4952 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4953 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4954 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4955 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4956 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4957
4958 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4959 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4960 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4961 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4962 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4963 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4964 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4965 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4966 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4967 downsides of rare connection failures.
4968
4969 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4970 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4971 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4972 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4973 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4974 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004975 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004976 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4977 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4978 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4979 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4980 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4981
4982 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004983 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
4984 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
4985 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004986
4987 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004988 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004989
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02004990 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
4991 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004992
4993 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4994 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4995 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4996
4997 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4998 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4999 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5000
5001 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5002
5003
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005004http-send-name-header [<header>]
5005 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5006
5007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5008 yes | no | yes | yes
5009
5010 Arguments :
5011
5012 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5013
5014 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005015 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005016 is added with the header string proved.
5017
5018 See also : "server"
5019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005020id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005021 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5023 no | yes | yes | yes
5024 Arguments : none
5025
5026 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5027 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5028 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005029
5030
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005031ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5032 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5033 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005034 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005035
5036 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5037 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5038 and running).
5039
5040 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5041 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5042 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005043 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005044 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5045
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005046 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5047 "unless" condition is met.
5048
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005049 Example:
5050 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5051 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5052 ignore-persist if url_static
5053
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005054 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5055
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005056load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5057 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5058 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5059 yes | no | yes | yes
5060
5061 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5062 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5063 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005064 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005065 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5066 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5067 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5068 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5069
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005070 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005071 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005072 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005073
5074 Arguments:
5075 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5076 named "server-state-file".
5077
5078 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5079 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5080 name is used as a file name.
5081
5082 none don't load any stat for this backend
5083
5084 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005085 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5086 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5087 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005088 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005089 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005090
5091 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5092 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5093
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005094 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005095
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005096 global
5097 stats socket /tmp/socket
5098 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005099
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005100 defaults
5101 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005102
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005103 backend bk
5104 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5105 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005106
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005107
5108 Then one can run :
5109
5110 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5111
5112 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5113
5114 1
5115 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5116 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5117 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5118
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005119 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005120
5121 global
5122 stats socket /tmp/socket
5123 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5124
5125 defaults
5126 load-server-state-from-file local
5127
5128 backend bk
5129 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5130 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5131
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005132
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005133 Then one can run :
5134
5135 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5136
5137 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5138
5139 1
5140 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5141 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5142 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5143
5144 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5145 "show servers state"
5146
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005147
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005148log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005149log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005150no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005151 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5153 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005154
5155 Prefix :
5156 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5157 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5158 prefix does not allow arguments.
5159
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005160 Arguments :
5161 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5162 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5163 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5164 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5165 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5166 parameter.
5167
5168 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5169 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5170
5171 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5172 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5173 standard syslog port).
5174
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005175 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5176 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5177 standard syslog port).
5178
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005179 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5180 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5181 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005182 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005183
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005184 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5185 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5186 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5187 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5188 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5189 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5190 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5191 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5192 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5193 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5194 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5195 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5196 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5197 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5198 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5199 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005200 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5201 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005202
5203 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5204 and "fd@2", see above.
5205
5206 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5207 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005208
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005209 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5210 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5211 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5212 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5213 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5214 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5215 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5216 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5217 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5218 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005219 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005220
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005221 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5222 one of the following :
5223
5224 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5225 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5226
5227 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5228 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5229
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005230 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5231 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5232 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5233 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5234 systemd logger consumes.
5235
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005236 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5237 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5238 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5239 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5240
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005241 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5242
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005243 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5244 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5245 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5246
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005247 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5248 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5249 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5250 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005251
5252 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5253 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5254 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005255 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5256 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5257 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5258 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5259 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005260
5261 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5262
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005263 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5264 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5265 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005266
5267 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5268 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5269 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5270 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5271
5272 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5273 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005274
5275 Example :
5276 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005277 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5278 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5279 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005280 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5281 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005282 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005283
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005284
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005285log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005286 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5287 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5288 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005289
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005290 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5291 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5292 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5293 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5294 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005295
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005296 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5297 "option httplog" directives.
5298
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005299log-format-sd <string>
5300 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5301 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5302 yes | yes | yes | no
5303
5304 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5305 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5306 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5307 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5308 which covers the log format string in depth.
5309
5310 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5311 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5312
5313 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5314 log format to "rfc5424".
5315
5316 Example :
5317 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5318
5319
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005320log-tag <string>
5321 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5322 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5323 yes | yes | yes | yes
5324
5325 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5326 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5327 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5328 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5329 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5330 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5331 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5332 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5333 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005334
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005335max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5336 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5337 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5338 yes | no | yes | yes
5339
5340 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5341 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5342 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5343 servers.
5344
5345 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5346 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5347 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5348 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5349 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005350 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005351 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5352 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5353 picking a different server.
5354
5355 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5356 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5357 even if they have to be queued.
5358
5359 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5360 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5361
5362
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005363maxconn <conns>
5364 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5366 yes | yes | yes | no
5367 Arguments :
5368 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5369 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5370 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5371 closes.
5372
5373 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5374 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5375 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5376 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005377 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5378 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5379 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5380 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005381
5382 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5383 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5384 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5385
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005386 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5387
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005388 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5389
5390
5391mode { tcp|http|health }
5392 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5394 yes | yes | yes | yes
5395 Arguments :
5396 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5397 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5398 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5399 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5400
5401 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5402 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5403 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5404 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5405 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5406
5407 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005408 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5409 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5410 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5411 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5412 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5413 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5414 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005415
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005416 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5417 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5418 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005419
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005420 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005421 defaults http_instances
5422 mode http
5423
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005424 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005426
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005427monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005428 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5430 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005431 Arguments :
5432 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5433 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005434 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005435 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5436 backend and its backup.
5437
5438 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5439 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5440 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5441 servers in a list of backends.
5442
5443 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5444 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5445 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5446 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5447 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5448 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5449 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005450 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5451 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005452
5453 Example:
5454 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005455 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005456 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5457 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5458 monitor-uri /site_alive
5459 monitor fail if site_dead
5460
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005461 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005462
5463
5464monitor-net <source>
5465 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5467 yes | yes | yes | no
5468 Arguments :
5469 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5470 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5471 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5472 followed by a mask.
5473
5474 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5475 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005476 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005477 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5478
5479 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5480 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5481 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5482 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005483 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5484 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5485 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005486
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005487 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5488 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5489 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5490 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5491 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5492 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005493
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005494 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5495 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005496
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005497 Example :
5498 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5499 frontend www
5500 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5501
5502 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5503
5504
5505monitor-uri <uri>
5506 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5508 yes | yes | yes | no
5509 Arguments :
5510 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5511 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5512
5513 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5514 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5515 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5516 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5517 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5518 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5519 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5520 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5521
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005522 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5523 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5524 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5525 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5526 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5527 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5528 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5529 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005530
5531 Example :
5532 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5533 frontend www
5534 mode http
5535 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5536
5537 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005539
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005540option abortonclose
5541no option abortonclose
5542 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5544 yes | no | yes | yes
5545 Arguments : none
5546
5547 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5548 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5549 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5550 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005551 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005552 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5553 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5554 encountered while delivering the response.
5555
5556 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5557 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5558 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5559 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5560 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5561 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005562 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005563 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005564 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005565 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5566 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5567 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5568
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005569 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5570 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005571 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5572 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5573 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5574 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5575 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5576 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005577 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005578
5579 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5580 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5581
5582 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5583
5584
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005585option accept-invalid-http-request
5586no option accept-invalid-http-request
5587 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5589 yes | yes | yes | no
5590 Arguments : none
5591
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005592 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005593 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005594 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005595 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5596 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5597 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5598 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5599 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005600 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5601 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5602 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5603 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005604 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005605 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005606 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5607 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5608 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005609
5610 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5611 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5612 been confirmed.
5613
5614 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5615 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005616 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5617 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005618 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5619
5620 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5621 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5622
5623 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5624 stats socket.
5625
5626
5627option accept-invalid-http-response
5628no option accept-invalid-http-response
5629 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5631 yes | no | yes | yes
5632 Arguments : none
5633
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005634 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005635 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005636 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005637 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5638 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5639 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5640 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5641 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005642 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5643 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5644 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005645
5646 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5647 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5648 been confirmed.
5649
5650 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5651 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5652 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5653 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5654
5655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5657
5658 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5659 stats socket.
5660
5661
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005662option allbackups
5663no option allbackups
5664 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5666 yes | no | yes | yes
5667 Arguments : none
5668
5669 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5670 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5671 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5672 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5673 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5674 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5675 order between the backup servers anymore.
5676
5677 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5678 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5679
5680 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5681 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5682
5683
5684option checkcache
5685no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005686 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5688 yes | no | yes | yes
5689 Arguments : none
5690
5691 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5692 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005693 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005694 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5695 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005696 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005697
5698 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005699 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005700 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005701 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5702 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005703 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005704 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005705 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5706 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005707 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005708 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5709 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005710 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005711 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5712 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5713 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5714 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5715 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5716 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5717 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5718 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5719 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5720
5721 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005722 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005723 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005724 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005725 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5726
5727 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5728 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005729 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005730 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005731
5732 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5733 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5734
5735
5736option clitcpka
5737no option clitcpka
5738 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5740 yes | yes | yes | no
5741 Arguments : none
5742
5743 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5744 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005745 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005746 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5747
5748 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5749 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5750 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5751 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5752
5753 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5754 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5755 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5756 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5757 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5758
5759 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5760
5761 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5762 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5763 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5764
5765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5767
5768 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5769
5770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005771option contstats
5772 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5774 yes | yes | yes | no
5775 Arguments : none
5776
5777 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5778 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5779 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5780 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005781 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5782 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5783 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5784 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5785 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005786
5787
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005788option dontlog-normal
5789no option dontlog-normal
5790 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5792 yes | yes | yes | no
5793 Arguments : none
5794
5795 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5796 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5797 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5798 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5799 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5800 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5801 logged.
5802
5803 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5804 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5805 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005807 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005808 logging.
5809
5810
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005811option dontlognull
5812no option dontlognull
5813 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5815 yes | yes | yes | no
5816 Arguments : none
5817
5818 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5819 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5820 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5821 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5822 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5823 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005824 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5825 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5826 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005827
5828 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005829 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005830 would not be logged.
5831
5832 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5833 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5834
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005835 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5836 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005837
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005838
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005839option forceclose (deprecated)
5840no option forceclose (deprecated)
5841 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005842
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005843 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005844
5845
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005846option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005847 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5849 yes | yes | yes | yes
5850 Arguments :
5851 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5852 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005853 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005854 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005855
5856 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5857 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5858 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5859 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5860 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5861 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5862 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005863 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5864 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5865 possible that the client has already brought one.
5866
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005867 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005868 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005869 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005870 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005871 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005872 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005873
5874 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5875 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5876 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5877 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5878 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5879 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5880 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5881
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005882 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5883 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5884 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5885 are under the control of the end-user.
5886
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005887 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005888 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5889 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005890 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5891 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5892 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005893
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005894 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005895 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5896 frontend www
5897 mode http
5898 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5899
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005900 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5901 backend www
5902 mode http
5903 option forwardfor header X-Client
5904
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005905 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005906 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005907
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005908
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005909option http-buffer-request
5910no option http-buffer-request
5911 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5913 yes | yes | yes | yes
5914 Arguments : none
5915
5916 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5917 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5918 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5919 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5920 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5921 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5922 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5923 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005924 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005925 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5926 default.
5927
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005928 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005929
5930
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005931option http-ignore-probes
5932no option http-ignore-probes
5933 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5935 yes | yes | yes | no
5936 Arguments : none
5937
5938 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5939 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5940 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5941 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5942 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5943 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5944 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5945 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5946 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005947 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5948 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005949 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5950
5951 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5952 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5953 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5954 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5955 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5956 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5957 are often the only way to detect them.
5958
5959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5961
5962 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5963
5964
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005965option http-keep-alive
5966no option http-keep-alive
5967 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5969 yes | yes | yes | yes
5970 Arguments : none
5971
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005972 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5973 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005974 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5975 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5976 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
5977 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
5978 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005979
5980 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5981 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005982 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5983 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5984 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5985 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5986 situations where this option may be useful :
5987
5988 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005989 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005990
5991 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5992 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5993
5994 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5995 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5996 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5997 request.
5998
5999 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6000 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006001 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6002 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6003 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006004
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006005 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6006 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6007 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6008 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6009 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6010 not set.
6011
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006012 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006013 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6014 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006015
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006016 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006017 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006018 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006019
6020
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006021option http-no-delay
6022no option http-no-delay
6023 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6025 yes | yes | yes | yes
6026 Arguments : none
6027
6028 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6029 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6030 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6031 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6032 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6033 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6034 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6035 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6036 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6037 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6038 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6039 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6040 affected.
6041
6042 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6043 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6044 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6045 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6046 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6047 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6048 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6049 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6050 latency environments.
6051
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006052 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6053
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006054
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006055option http-pretend-keepalive
6056no option http-pretend-keepalive
6057 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006059 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006060 Arguments : none
6061
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006062 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006063 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6064 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6065 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6066 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6067 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6068 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6069 consider the response complete.
6070
6071 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6072 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6073 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6074 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006075 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006076 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6077
6078 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6079 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6080 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6081 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6082 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6083 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6084 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6085
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006086 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6087 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6088 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6089 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6090 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6091 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006092
6093 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6094 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6095
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006096 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006097 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006098
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006099
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006100option http-server-close
6101no option http-server-close
6102 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6104 yes | yes | yes | yes
6105 Arguments : none
6106
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006107 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6108 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6109 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6110 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006111 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6112 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6113 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6114 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6115 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6116 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6117 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6118 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6119 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6120 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6121 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006122
6123 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6124 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6125 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6126 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006127 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6128 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006129
6130 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6131 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006132 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6133 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6134 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006135
6136 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6137 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6138
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006139 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6140 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006141
6142
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006143option http-tunnel
6144no option http-tunnel
6145 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006147 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006148 Arguments : none
6149
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006150 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6151 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6152 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6153 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006154 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006155
6156 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006157 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006158 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6159 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6160 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6161 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6162 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6163 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6164 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006165
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006166 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6167 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6168 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6169 backend.
6170
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006171 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6172 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6173
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006174 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6175 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006176
6177
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006178option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006179no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006180 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6182 yes | yes | yes | no
6183 Arguments : none
6184
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006185 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006186 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6187 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6188 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6189 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6190 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6191 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6192
6193 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6194 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006195 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6196 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6197 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006198
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006199 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6200 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6201 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6202 front of an existing proxy.
6203
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006204 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6205
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006206 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006207
6208
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006209option http-use-htx
6210no option http-use-htx
6211 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6213 yes | yes | yes | yes
6214 Arguments : none
6215
6216 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6217 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6218 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6219 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6220 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6221 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6222 representation.
6223
6224 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6225 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6226 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6227 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6228 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6229 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6230 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6231 other side's version.
6232
6233 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6234 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6235 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6236 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6237 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6238
6239 See also : "mode http"
6240
6241
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006242option httpchk
6243option httpchk <uri>
6244option httpchk <method> <uri>
6245option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6246 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6248 yes | no | yes | yes
6249 Arguments :
6250 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6251 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6252 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6253 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6254 ones.
6255
6256 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6257 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6258 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6259
6260 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6261 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6262 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6263 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6264 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6265
6266 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6267 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6268 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6269 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6270 the lack of any response.
6271
6272 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6273
6274 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6275 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6276 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6277
6278 Examples :
6279 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6280 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6281 backend https_relay
6282 mode tcp
6283 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6284 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6285
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006286 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6287 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6288 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006289
6290
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006291option httpclose
6292no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006293 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6295 yes | yes | yes | yes
6296 Arguments : none
6297
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006298 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6299 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6300 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6301 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006302 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006303
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006304 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6305 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6306 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6307 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6308 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006309
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006310 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6311 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6312 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006313
6314 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6315 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006316 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006317 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6318 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6319 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006320
6321 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6322 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6323
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006324 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006325
6326
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006327option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006328 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006330 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006331 Arguments :
6332 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6333 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6334 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006335 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006336 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006337
6338 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6339 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6340 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6341 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6342 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6343 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6344 ports.
6345
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006346 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6347 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006348
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006349 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006351 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006352
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006353
6354option http_proxy
6355no option http_proxy
6356 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6358 yes | yes | yes | yes
6359 Arguments : none
6360
6361 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6362 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6363 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6364 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6365 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6366
6367 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6368 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006369 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6370 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006371
6372 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6373 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6374
6375 Example :
6376 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6377 backend direct_forward
6378 option httpclose
6379 option http_proxy
6380
6381 See also : "option httpclose"
6382
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006383
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006384option independent-streams
6385no option independent-streams
6386 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6388 yes | yes | yes | yes
6389 Arguments : none
6390
6391 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6392 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6393 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6394 receive data or not.
6395
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006396 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006397 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6398 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6399 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6400 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6401 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6402 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6403 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6404 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6405 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6406 socket buffers.
6407
6408 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6409 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6410 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6411 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6412 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6413
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006414 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006415 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6416 deprecated.
6417
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006418 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006419
6420
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006421option ldap-check
6422 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6424 yes | no | yes | yes
6425 Arguments : none
6426
6427 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6428 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6429 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6430 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6431
6432 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6433 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6434
6435 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6436 configure it.
6437
6438 Example :
6439 option ldap-check
6440
6441 See also : "option httpchk"
6442
6443
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006444option external-check
6445 Use external processes for server health checks
6446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6447 yes | no | yes | yes
6448
6449 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6450 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6451 command".
6452
6453 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6454
6455 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6456
6457
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006458option log-health-checks
6459no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006460 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6462 yes | no | yes | yes
6463 Arguments : none
6464
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006465 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6466 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6467 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006468
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006469 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6470 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6471 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6472 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6473 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6474
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006475 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006476 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006477
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006478 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6479 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6480 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006481
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006482
6483option log-separate-errors
6484no option log-separate-errors
6485 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6487 yes | yes | yes | no
6488 Arguments : none
6489
6490 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6491 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6492 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6493 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6494 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6495 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6496 provides very important information.
6497
6498 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6499 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6500 error logs.
6501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006502 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006503 logging.
6504
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006505
6506option logasap
6507no option logasap
6508 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6510 yes | yes | yes | no
6511 Arguments : none
6512
6513 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6514 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6515 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6516 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6517 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6518 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6519 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006520 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006521 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6522 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6523
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006524 Examples :
6525 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6526 mode http
6527 option httplog
6528 option logasap
6529 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6530
6531 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6532 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6533 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6534 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006536 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006537 logging.
6538
6539
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006540option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006541 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6543 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006544 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006545 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6546 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006547 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006548
6549 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6550 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006551 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006552 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6553 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6554 in the MySQL table, like this :
6555
6556 USE mysql;
6557 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6558 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6559
6560 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006561 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006562 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6563 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6564 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6565 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6566 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6567 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6568 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6569
6570 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6571 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006572
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006573 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006574
6575 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6576 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6577 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6578 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006579 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6580 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006581
6582 See also: "option httpchk"
6583
6584
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006585option nolinger
6586no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006587 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006588 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6589 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006590 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006591
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006592 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006593 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6594 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6595 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6596 connections.
6597
6598 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6599 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6600 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6601 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6602 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6603 this too.
6604
6605 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6606 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6607 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6608
6609 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6610 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6611 for servers.
6612
6613 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6614 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6615
6616
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006617option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6618 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6620 yes | yes | yes | yes
6621 Arguments :
6622 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6623 matching <network>
6624 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6625 header name.
6626
6627 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6628 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6629 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6630 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6631 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6632 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6633 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6634 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6635 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6636 possible that the client has already brought one.
6637
6638 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6639 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6640 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6641 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6642 header and requires different one.
6643
6644 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6645 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6646 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6647 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6648 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6649 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6650 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6651
6652 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6653 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6654 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6655 both are defined.
6656
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006657 Examples :
6658 # Original Destination address
6659 frontend www
6660 mode http
6661 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6662
6663 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6664 backend www
6665 mode http
6666 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6667
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006668 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006669
6670
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006671option persist
6672no option persist
6673 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6674 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6675 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006676 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006677
6678 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6679 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6680 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6681 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6682 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6683 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6684 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6685 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6686 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6687 redirected to another valid server.
6688
6689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6691
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006692 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006693
6694
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006695option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6696 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6698 yes | no | yes | yes
6699 Arguments :
6700 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6701 PostgreSQL server.
6702
6703 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6704 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6705 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6706 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6707
6708 See also: "option httpchk"
6709
6710
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006711option prefer-last-server
6712no option prefer-last-server
6713 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6714 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6715 yes | no | yes | yes
6716 Arguments : none
6717
6718 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6719 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6720 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6721 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6722 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6723 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6724 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6725 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6726 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006727 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6728 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006729 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6730 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6731 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006732 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6733 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6734 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006735
6736 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6737 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6738
6739 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6740
6741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006742option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006743option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006744no option redispatch
6745 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6746 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6747 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006748 Arguments :
6749 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6750 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6751 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006752 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006753 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006754 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006755 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6756 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6757 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006759
6760 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6761 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6762 be able to access the service anymore.
6763
6764 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6765 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6766
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006767 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006768 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6769 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006771 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6772 "redisp" keywords.
6773
6774 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6775 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6776
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006777 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006778
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006779
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006780option redis-check
6781 Use redis health checks for server testing
6782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6783 yes | no | yes | yes
6784 Arguments : none
6785
6786 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6787 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6788 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6789 find the "+PONG" response message.
6790
6791 Example :
6792 option redis-check
6793
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006794 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006795
6796
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006797option smtpchk
6798option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6799 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6801 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006802 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006803 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006804 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006805 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6806
6807 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6808 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6809 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6810
6811 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6812 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6813 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6814 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6815 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6816 dead server.
6817
6818 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6819 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006820 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006821 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6822
6823 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6824 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6825 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6826 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006827 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006828
6829 Example :
6830 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6831
6832 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006834
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006835option socket-stats
6836no option socket-stats
6837
6838 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6840 yes | yes | yes | no
6841
6842 Arguments : none
6843
6844
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006845option splice-auto
6846no option splice-auto
6847 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6849 yes | yes | yes | yes
6850 Arguments : none
6851
6852 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6853 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006854 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006855 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006856 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006857 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6858 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6859 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6860 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6861
6862 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6863 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6864 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6865 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6866 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6867 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6868 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6869 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6870 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6871 keyword.
6872
6873 Example :
6874 option splice-auto
6875
6876 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6877 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6878
6879 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6880 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6881
6882
6883option splice-request
6884no option splice-request
6885 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6887 yes | yes | yes | yes
6888 Arguments : none
6889
6890 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006891 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006892 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6893 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6894 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6895 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6896
6897 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6898
6899 Example :
6900 option splice-request
6901
6902 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6903 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6904
6905 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6906 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6907
6908
6909option splice-response
6910no option splice-response
6911 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6913 yes | yes | yes | yes
6914 Arguments : none
6915
6916 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006917 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006918 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6919 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6920 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6921 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6922
6923 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6924
6925 Example :
6926 option splice-response
6927
6928 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6929 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6930
6931 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6932 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6933
6934
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006935option spop-check
6936 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6938 no | no | no | yes
6939 Arguments : none
6940
6941 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6942 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6943 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6944 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6945
6946 Example :
6947 option spop-check
6948
6949 See also : "option httpchk"
6950
6951
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006952option srvtcpka
6953no option srvtcpka
6954 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6956 yes | no | yes | yes
6957 Arguments : none
6958
6959 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6960 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006961 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006962 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6963
6964 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6965 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6966 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6967 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6968
6969 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6970 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6971 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6972 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6973 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6974
6975 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6976
6977 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6978 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6979 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6980
6981 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6982 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6983
6984 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6985
6986
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006987option ssl-hello-chk
6988 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6990 yes | no | yes | yes
6991 Arguments : none
6992
6993 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6994 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6995 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6996 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6997 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6998 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6999 hello message.
7000
7001 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7002 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7003 messages, which is appreciable.
7004
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007005 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7006 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7007 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007008
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007009 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7010
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007011
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007012option tcp-check
7013 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7014 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7015 yes | no | yes | yes
7016
7017 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7018 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7019
7020 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7021 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7022 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7023
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007024 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007025 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7026 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7027 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7028 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7029 only.
7030
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007031 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007032 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7033 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7034 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7035 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7036
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007037 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007038 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7039 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007040 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007041 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7042 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7043 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7044 the respective protocols.
7045 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007046 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007047
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007048 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7049 script.
7050
7051 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7052 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7053 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7054 The "comment" is of course optional.
7055
7056
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007057 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007058 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007059 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007060 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007061
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007062 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007063 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007064 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007065
7066 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7067 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007068 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007069 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007070 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007071 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007072 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007073 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007074 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7075 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007076 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007077 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7078 tcp-check expect string +OK
7079
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007080 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007081 (send many headers before analyzing)
7082 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007083 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007084 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7085 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7086 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7087 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007088 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007089
7090
7091 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7092
7093
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007094option tcp-smart-accept
7095no option tcp-smart-accept
7096 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7098 yes | yes | yes | no
7099 Arguments : none
7100
7101 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7102 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7103 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7104 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7105 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7106 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7107
7108 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7109 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7110 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7111 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7112
7113 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7114 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7115 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007116 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007117
7118 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7119 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7120 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7121
7122 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7123 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7124 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7125
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007126 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7127
7128
7129option tcp-smart-connect
7130no option tcp-smart-connect
7131 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7133 yes | no | yes | yes
7134 Arguments : none
7135
7136 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7137 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7138 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7139 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7140 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7141
7142 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7143 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7144 complex.
7145
7146 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7147 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7148 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7149
7150 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7151 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7152
7153 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7154
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007155
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007156option tcpka
7157 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7159 yes | yes | yes | yes
7160 Arguments : none
7161
7162 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7163 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007164 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007165 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7166
7167 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7168 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7169 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7170 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7171
7172 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7173 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7174 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7175 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7176 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7177
7178 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7179
7180 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7181 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7182 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7183 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7184 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7185 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7186 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7187 backends.
7188
7189 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7190
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007191
7192option tcplog
7193 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007195 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007196 Arguments : none
7197
7198 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7199 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7200 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7201 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7202 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7203 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7204 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7205 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7206
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007207 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007209 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007210
7211
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007212option transparent
7213no option transparent
7214 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007216 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007217 Arguments : none
7218
7219 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7220 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7221 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7222 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7223 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7224 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7225 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7226 appropriate server.
7227
7228 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7229 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7230
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007231 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007232 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007233
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007234
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007235external-check command <command>
7236 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7238 yes | no | yes | yes
7239
7240 Arguments :
7241 <command> is the external command to run
7242
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007243 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7244
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007245 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007246
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007247 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7248 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7249 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7250 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7251 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7252 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007253
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007254 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7255
7256 Environment variables :
7257 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7258 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7259
7260 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7261
7262 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7263
7264 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7265 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7266 for a UNIX socket).
7267
7268 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7269
7270 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7271
7272 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7273
7274 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7275
7276 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7277
7278 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7279 socket).
7280
7281 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7282 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7283
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007284 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7285 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7286 failed.
7287
7288 Example :
7289 external-check command /bin/true
7290
7291 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7292
7293
7294external-check path <path>
7295 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7297 yes | no | yes | yes
7298
7299 Arguments :
7300 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7301
7302 The default path is "".
7303
7304 Example :
7305 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7306
7307 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7308 "external-check command"
7309
7310
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007311persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007312persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007313 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7315 yes | no | yes | yes
7316 Arguments :
7317 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007318 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7319 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007320
7321 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7322 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007323 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007324 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7325 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7326 forwarded to this server.
7327
7328 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7329 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7330 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007331 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007332 a single "listen" section.
7333
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007334 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7335 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7336 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7337
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007338 Example :
7339 listen tse-farm
7340 bind :3389
7341 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7342 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7343 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7344 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7345 persist rdp-cookie
7346 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007347 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007348 balance rdp-cookie
7349 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7350 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7351
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007352 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7353 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007354
7355
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007356rate-limit sessions <rate>
7357 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7359 yes | yes | yes | no
7360 Arguments :
7361 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7362 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7363
7364 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7365 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7366 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7367 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7368 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7369 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7370
7371 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7372 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7373 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7374 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7375
7376 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7377 listen smtp
7378 mode tcp
7379 bind :25
7380 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007381 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007382
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007383 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7384 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7385 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007386
7387 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7388
7389
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007390redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7391redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7392redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007393 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7395 no | yes | yes | yes
7396
7397 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007398 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007399
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007400 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007401 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007402 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7403 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7404 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007405
7406 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7407 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7408 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7409 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7410 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007411 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7412 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7413 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7414 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007415
7416 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7417 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7418 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7419 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7420 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7421 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007422 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007423 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007424 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7425 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7426 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007427
7428 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007429 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7430 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7431 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007432 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007433 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7434 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7435 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7436 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007437
7438 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007439 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007440
7441 - "drop-query"
7442 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7443 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7444 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7445 with a location-type redirect.
7446
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007447 - "append-slash"
7448 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7449 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7450 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7451 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7452
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007453 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7454 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7455 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7456 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7457 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7458 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7459 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7460
7461 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7462 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7463 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7464 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7465 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7466 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7467 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007468
7469 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7470 acl clear dst_port 80
7471 acl secure dst_port 8080
7472 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007473 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007474 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007475 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7476
7477 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007478 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7479 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7480 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007481 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007482
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007483 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7484 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7485 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7486
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007487 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007488 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007489
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007490 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007491 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7492 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7493 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007495 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007496
7497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007498redisp (deprecated)
7499redispatch (deprecated)
7500 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7501 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7502 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007503 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007504
7505 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7506 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7507 be able to access the service anymore.
7508
7509 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7510 redistribute them to a working server.
7511
7512 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7513 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7514 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007516 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7517 "option redispatch" instead.
7518
7519 See also : "option redispatch"
7520
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007521
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007522reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007523 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7525 no | yes | yes | yes
7526 Arguments :
7527 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7528 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007529 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007530
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007531 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7532 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7533
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007534 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7535 the last header of an HTTP request.
7536
7537 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7538 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7539 responses.
7540
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007541 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7542 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7543 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7544
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007545 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7546 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007547
7548
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007549reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7550reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007551 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7553 no | yes | yes | yes
7554 Arguments :
7555 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7556 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7557 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7558 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7559 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7560 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7561 ignores case.
7562
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007563 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7564 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7565
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007566 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7567 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7568 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7569 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007570 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007571
7572 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7573 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7574
7575 Example :
7576 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7577 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7578 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7579
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007580 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7581 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007582
7583
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007584reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7585reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007586 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7588 no | yes | yes | yes
7589 Arguments :
7590 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7591 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7592 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7593 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7594 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7595 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7596
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007597 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7598 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7599
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007600 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7601 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7602 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7603 next servers.
7604
7605 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7606 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7607 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7608
7609 Example :
7610 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7611 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7612 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7613
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007614 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7615 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007616
7617
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007618reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7619reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007620 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7622 no | yes | yes | yes
7623 Arguments :
7624 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7625 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7626 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7627 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7628 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7629 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7630 case.
7631
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007632 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7633 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7634
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007635 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7636 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7637 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7638 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007639 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007640
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007641 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007642 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007643 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007644
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007645 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7646 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7647
7648 Example :
7649 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7650 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7651 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7652
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007653 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7654 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007655
7656
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007657reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7658reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007659 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7661 no | yes | yes | yes
7662 Arguments :
7663 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7664 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7665 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7666 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7667 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7668 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7669 case.
7670
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007671 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7672 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7673
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007674 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7675 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7676 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7677 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7678
7679 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7680 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7681
7682 Example :
7683 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7684 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7685 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7686 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7687
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007688 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7689 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007690
7691
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007692reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7693reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007694 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7696 no | yes | yes | yes
7697 Arguments :
7698 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7699 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7700 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7701 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7702 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7703 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7704
7705 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7706 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7707 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7708 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007709 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007710
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007711 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7712 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7713
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007714 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7715 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7716 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7717
7718 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7719 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7720 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7721 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7722 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7723
7724 Example :
7725 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007726 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007727 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7728 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7729
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007730 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7731 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007732
7733
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007734reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7735reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007736 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7738 no | yes | yes | yes
7739 Arguments :
7740 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7741 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7742 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7743 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7744 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7745 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7746 ignores case.
7747
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007748 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7749 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7750
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007751 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7752 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007753 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7754 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7755 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007756 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7757 not set.
7758
7759 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7760 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7761 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7762 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7763 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7764
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007765 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007766 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007767 # block all others.
7768 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7769 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7770
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007771 # block bad guys
7772 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7773 reqitarpit . if badguys
7774
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007775 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7776 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007777
7778
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007779retries <value>
7780 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7781 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7782 yes | no | yes | yes
7783 Arguments :
7784 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7785 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7786 default value is 3.
7787
7788 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7789 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7790 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7791
7792 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007793 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7794 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007795
7796 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7797 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7798
7799 See also : "option redispatch"
7800
7801
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007802rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007803 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7805 no | yes | yes | yes
7806 Arguments :
7807 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7808 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007809 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007810
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007811 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7812 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7813
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007814 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7815 the last header of an HTTP response.
7816
7817 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7818 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7819 responses.
7820
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007821 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7822 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007823
7824
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007825rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7826rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007827 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7829 no | yes | yes | yes
7830 Arguments :
7831 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7832 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7833 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7834 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7835 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7836 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7837 ignores case.
7838
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007839 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7840 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7841
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007842 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7843 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007844 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007845 client.
7846
7847 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7848 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7849 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7850
7851 Example :
7852 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007853 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007854
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007855 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7856 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007857
7858
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007859rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7860rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007861 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7863 no | yes | yes | yes
7864 Arguments :
7865 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7866 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7867 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7868 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7869 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7870 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7871 ignores case.
7872
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007873 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7874 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7875
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007876 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7877 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7878 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7879 case-sensitive.
7880
7881 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007882 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7883 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7884 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007885
7886 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7887 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7888
7889 Example :
7890 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7891 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7892
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007893 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7894 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007895
7896
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007897rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7898rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007899 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7901 no | yes | yes | yes
7902 Arguments :
7903 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7904 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7905 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7906 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7907 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7908 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7909 ignores case.
7910
7911 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7912 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7913 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7914 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007915 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007916
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007917 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7918 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7919
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007920 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7921 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7922 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7923
7924 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7925 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7926 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7927 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7928 are not case-sensitive.
7929
7930 Example :
7931 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7932 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7933
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007934 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7935 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007936
7937
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007938server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007939 Declare a server in a backend
7940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7941 no | no | yes | yes
7942 Arguments :
7943 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007944 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007945 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007946
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007947 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7948 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7949 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7950 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007951 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7952 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7953 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7954 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7955 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007956 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7957 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7958 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7959 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7960 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7961 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7962 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007963 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007964 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7965 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7966 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7967 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7968 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7969 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007970 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7971 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007972 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7973 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007974
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007975 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007976 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7977 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7978 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7979 adding this value to the client's port.
7980
7981 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7982 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007983 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007984
7985 Examples :
7986 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7987 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007988 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007989 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7990 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7991 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007992
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007993 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7994 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7995 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7996 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7997 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7998
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007999 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8000 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008001
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008002server-state-file-name [<file>]
8003 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8004 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8005 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8006 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8007 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8008 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8009
8010 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8011 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8012
8013 global
8014 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8015
8016 backend bk
8017 load-server-state-from-file
8018
8019 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8020 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008021
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008022server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8023 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8024 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8026 no | no | yes | yes
8027
8028 Arguments:
8029 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8030
8031 <num | range>
8032 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8033 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8034 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8035 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8036
8037 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8038
8039 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8040
8041 <params*>
8042 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8043 keyword.
8044
8045 Examples:
8046 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8047 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8048 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8049
8050 # or
8051 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8052
8053 # would be equivalent to:
8054 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8055 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8056 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8057
8058
8059
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008060source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008061source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008062source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008063 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8065 yes | no | yes | yes
8066 Arguments :
8067 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8068 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008069
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008070 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008071 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8072 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8073 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8074 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8075 supported prefixes are :
8076 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8077 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8078 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008079 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008080 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8081 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008082
8083 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8084 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008085 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8086 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8087 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008088
8089 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8090 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8091 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8092 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8093 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8094 <addr>.
8095
8096 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8097 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8098 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8099 port.
8100
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008101 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8102 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8103 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8104 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008105 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008106 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8107 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8108 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8109 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8110 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8111 HTTP header.
8112
8113 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8114 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008115 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008116 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8117 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8118 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8119 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8120 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8121 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8122 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8123
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008124 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8125 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8126 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8127 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8128 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8129 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8130
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008131 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8132 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8133 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8134 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8135
8136 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8137 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8138 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8139 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8140 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8141 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8142
8143 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8144 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8145 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8146 there are two methods :
8147
8148 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8149 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8150 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8151 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8152 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8153 of the client ranges may be used.
8154
8155 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8156 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8157 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8158 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8159 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8160 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8161 same session.
8162
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008163 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8164 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8165 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008166 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008167
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008168 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8169
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008170 Examples :
8171 backend private
8172 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8173 source 192.168.1.200
8174
8175 backend transparent_ssl1
8176 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8177 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8178
8179 backend transparent_ssl2
8180 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8181 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8182 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8183
8184 backend transparent_ssl3
8185 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8186 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8187 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8188
8189 backend transparent_smtp
8190 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8191 # with Tproxy version 4.
8192 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8193
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008194 backend transparent_http
8195 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8196 # proxy.
8197 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008199 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008200 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008202
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008203srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8204 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8206 yes | no | yes | yes
8207 Arguments :
8208 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8209 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8210 as explained at the top of this document.
8211
8212 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8213 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8214 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8215 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8216 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8217 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8218 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8219
8220 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8221 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8222 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8223 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8224 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008225 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008226 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008227 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008228
8229 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8230 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8231 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8232 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8233 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8234 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8235
8236 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8237 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8238
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008239 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8240 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008241
8242
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008243stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8244 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008246 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008247
8248 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8249 matched.
8250
8251 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8252 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8253
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008254 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8255 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008256 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008257
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008258 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8259 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8260 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8261 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008262
8263 Example :
8264 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8265 backend stats_localhost
8266 stats enable
8267 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8268
8269 Example :
8270 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8271 backend stats_auth
8272 stats enable
8273 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8274 stats admin if TRUE
8275
8276 Example :
8277 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8278 userlist stats-auth
8279 group admin users admin
8280 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8281 group readonly users haproxy
8282 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8283
8284 backend stats_auth
8285 stats enable
8286 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8287 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8288 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8289 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8290
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008291 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8292 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8293 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008294
8295
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008296stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8297 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008299 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008300 Arguments :
8301 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8302
8303 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8304
8305 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8306 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8307 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8308 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8309 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8310 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8311
8312 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8313 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8314 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008315 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008316
8317 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8318 report using "stats scope".
8319
8320 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8321 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8322 unobvious parameters.
8323
8324 Example :
8325 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8326 backend public_www
8327 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8328 stats enable
8329 stats hide-version
8330 stats scope .
8331 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008332 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008333 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8334 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8335
8336 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8337 backend private_monitoring
8338 stats enable
8339 stats uri /admin?stats
8340 stats refresh 5s
8341
8342 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8343
8344
8345stats enable
8346 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008348 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008349 Arguments : none
8350
8351 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8352 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8353 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8354 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8355 - stats auth : no authentication
8356 - stats scope : no restriction
8357
8358 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8359 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8360 unobvious parameters.
8361
8362 Example :
8363 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8364 backend public_www
8365 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8366 stats enable
8367 stats hide-version
8368 stats scope .
8369 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008370 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008371 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8372 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8373
8374 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8375 backend private_monitoring
8376 stats enable
8377 stats uri /admin?stats
8378 stats refresh 5s
8379
8380 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8381
8382
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008383stats hide-version
8384 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008386 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008387 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008388
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008389 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8390 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8391 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8392 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8393 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8394 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008396 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8397 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8398 unobvious parameters.
8399
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008400 Example :
8401 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8402 backend public_www
8403 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008404 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008405 stats hide-version
8406 stats scope .
8407 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008408 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008409 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8410 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008411
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008412 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8413 backend private_monitoring
8414 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008415 stats uri /admin?stats
8416 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008417
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008418 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008419
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008420
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008421stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8422 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8423 Access control for statistics
8424
8425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8426 no | no | yes | yes
8427
8428 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8429 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8430 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8431 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8432 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8433 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8434
8435 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8436 instance.
8437
8438 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8439 about ACL usage.
8440
8441
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008442stats realm <realm>
8443 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008445 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008446 Arguments :
8447 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8448 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8449 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8450
8451 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8452 using a backslash ('\').
8453
8454 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8455 only related to authentication.
8456
8457 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8458 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8459 unobvious parameters.
8460
8461 Example :
8462 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8463 backend public_www
8464 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8465 stats enable
8466 stats hide-version
8467 stats scope .
8468 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008469 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008470 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8471 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8472
8473 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8474 backend private_monitoring
8475 stats enable
8476 stats uri /admin?stats
8477 stats refresh 5s
8478
8479 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8480
8481
8482stats refresh <delay>
8483 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008485 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008486 Arguments :
8487 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8488 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8489 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8490 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8491 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8492 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8493
8494 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8495 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8496 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8497 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8498
8499 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8500 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8501 unobvious parameters.
8502
8503 Example :
8504 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8505 backend public_www
8506 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8507 stats enable
8508 stats hide-version
8509 stats scope .
8510 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008511 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008512 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8513 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8514
8515 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8516 backend private_monitoring
8517 stats enable
8518 stats uri /admin?stats
8519 stats refresh 5s
8520
8521 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8522
8523
8524stats scope { <name> | "." }
8525 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008527 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008528 Arguments :
8529 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8530 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8531 section in which the statement appears.
8532
8533 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8534 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8535 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8536 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8537 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8538 exists.
8539
8540 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8541 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8542 unobvious parameters.
8543
8544 Example :
8545 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8546 backend public_www
8547 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8548 stats enable
8549 stats hide-version
8550 stats scope .
8551 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008552 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008553 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8554 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8555
8556 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8557 backend private_monitoring
8558 stats enable
8559 stats uri /admin?stats
8560 stats refresh 5s
8561
8562 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8563
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008564
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008565stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008566 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008568 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008569
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008570 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008571 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8572
8573 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8574 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8575
8576 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8577 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008578 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008579
8580 Example :
8581 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8582 backend private_monitoring
8583 stats enable
8584 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8585 stats uri /admin?stats
8586 stats refresh 5s
8587
8588 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8589 global section.
8590
8591
8592stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008593 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8595 yes | yes | yes | yes
8596 Arguments : none
8597
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008598 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008599 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8600 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8601 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8602 - IP (socket, server)
8603 - cookie (backend, server)
8604
8605 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8606 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008607 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008608
8609 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8610
8611
8612stats show-node [ <name> ]
8613 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008615 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008616 Arguments:
8617 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8618 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8619
8620 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8621 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008622 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008623
8624 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8625 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8626 unobvious parameters.
8627
8628 Example:
8629 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8630 backend private_monitoring
8631 stats enable
8632 stats show-node Europe-1
8633 stats uri /admin?stats
8634 stats refresh 5s
8635
8636 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8637 section.
8638
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008639
8640stats uri <prefix>
8641 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008643 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008644 Arguments :
8645 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8646 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8647 query string.
8648
8649 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8650 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8651 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8652 possible to reach it in the application.
8653
8654 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008655 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008656 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8657 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8658 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8659 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8660
8661 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8662 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8663 an address or a port to statistics only.
8664
8665 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8666 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8667 unobvious parameters.
8668
8669 Example :
8670 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8671 backend public_www
8672 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8673 stats enable
8674 stats hide-version
8675 stats scope .
8676 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008677 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008678 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8679 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8680
8681 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8682 backend private_monitoring
8683 stats enable
8684 stats uri /admin?stats
8685 stats refresh 5s
8686
8687 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8688
8689
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008690stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8691 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008693 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008694
8695 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008696 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008697 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008698 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008699 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8700
8701 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8702 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8703 the "stick-table" statement.
8704
8705 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8706 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8707 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8708 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8709 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8710
8711 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8712 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8713 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8714 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8715 transformation rules.
8716
8717 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8718 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8719 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8720 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8721 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8722 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8723 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8724
8725 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8726 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8727 ACL based conditions.
8728
8729 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8730 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8731 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8732 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8733
8734 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8735 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8736 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8737 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8738
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008739 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8740 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008741 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008742
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008743 Example :
8744 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8745 # last 30 minutes
8746 backend pop
8747 mode tcp
8748 balance roundrobin
8749 stick store-request src
8750 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8751 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8752 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8753
8754 backend smtp
8755 mode tcp
8756 balance roundrobin
8757 stick match src table pop
8758 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8759 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8760
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008761 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008762 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008763
8764
8765stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8766 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8768 no | no | yes | yes
8769
8770 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8771 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8772 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8773 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8774
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008775 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8776 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008777 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008778
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008779 Examples :
8780 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008781 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008782
8783 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8784 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8785 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8786
8787
8788 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8789 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8790 backend http
8791 mode http
8792 balance roundrobin
8793 stick on src table https
8794 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8795 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8796 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8797
8798 backend https
8799 mode tcp
8800 balance roundrobin
8801 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8802 stick on src
8803 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8804 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8805
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008806 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008807
8808
8809stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8810 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8812 no | no | yes | yes
8813
8814 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008815 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008816 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008817 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008818 server is selected.
8819
8820 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8821 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8822 the "stick-table" statement.
8823
8824 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8825 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8826 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8827 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8828 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8829 address.
8830
8831 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8832 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8833 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8834 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8835 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8836 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8837 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8838 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8839 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8840 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8841
8842 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8843 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8844 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8845 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8846 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8847 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8848 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8849
8850 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8851 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8852 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8853 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8854
8855 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8856 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8857 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8858 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8859 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8860 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008861 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8862 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8863 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8864 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8865 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8866 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008867
8868 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8869 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8870 the request.
8871
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008872 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8873 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008874 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008875
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008876 Example :
8877 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8878 # last 30 minutes
8879 backend pop
8880 mode tcp
8881 balance roundrobin
8882 stick store-request src
8883 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8884 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8885 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8886
8887 backend smtp
8888 mode tcp
8889 balance roundrobin
8890 stick match src table pop
8891 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8892 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8893
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008894 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008895 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008896
8897
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008898stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008899 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8900 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008901 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008903 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008904
8905 Arguments :
8906 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8907 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8908 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8909 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8910
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008911 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8912 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8913 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8914 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8915
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008916 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8917 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8918 instance.
8919
8920 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8921 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8922 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8923 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8924 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8925 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008926 to 32 characters.
8927
8928 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8929 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8930 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008931 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008932 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8933 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008934
8935 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008936 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8937 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008938 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8939 increase.
8940
8941 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008942 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8943 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8944 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008945
8946 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8947 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8948 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8949 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008950 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008951 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8952 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8953 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8954 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8955 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8956 parameter (see below).
8957
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008958 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8959 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8960 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8961 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8962 soft restart.
8963
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008964 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8965 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008966
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008967 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8968 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8969 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8970 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008971 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008972 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008973 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8974 if not expiration delay is specified.
8975
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008976 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8977 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8978 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8979 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008980 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8981 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8982 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8983 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8984 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8985 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8986 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8987 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8988 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8989 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8990 types and their arguments.
8991
8992 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8993 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8994 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8995 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8996
8997 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8998 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8999 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009000 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009001
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009002 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9003 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9004 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009005 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009006 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009007 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009008
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009009 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9010 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9011 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9012 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9013
9014 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9015 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9016 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9017 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9018 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9019 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9020
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009021 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9022 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9023 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9024 they were received.
9025
9026 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9027 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9028 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9029 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9030 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9031
9032 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9033 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9034 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9035 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9036 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9037
9038 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9039 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9040 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9041
9042 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9043 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9044 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9045 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9046 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9047
9048 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9049 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9050 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9051 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9052 the client side.
9053
9054 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9055 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9056 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9057 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9058 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9059 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9060 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9061
9062 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9063 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9064 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9065 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9066 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9067 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009068 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009069
9070 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9071 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9072 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9073 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9074 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9075 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9076
9077 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009078 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009079 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9080 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9081
9082 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9083 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9084 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9085 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9086 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9087 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9088 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9089 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9090 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9091 recommended for better fairness.
9092
9093 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009094 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009095 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9096 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9097
9098 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9099 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9100 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9101 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9102 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9103 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9104 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9105 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9106 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9107 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009108
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009109 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9110 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009111 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9112 reference it.
9113
9114 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9115 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009116 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9117 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9118 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009119
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009120 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9121 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9122 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9123 something that can be ignored.
9124
9125 Example:
9126 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9127 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9128 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9129 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9130
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009131 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009132 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009133
9134
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009135stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009136 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9138 no | no | yes | yes
9139
9140 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009141 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009142 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009143 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009144 server is selected.
9145
9146 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9147 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9148 the "stick-table" statement.
9149
9150 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9151 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9152 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9153 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9154
9155 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9156 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9157 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9158 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9159 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9160 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009161 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009162 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9163 rules.
9164
9165 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9166 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9167 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9168 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9169 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9170 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9171 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9172
9173 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9174 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9175 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9176 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9177
9178 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9179 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9180 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9181 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9182 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9183 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009184 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9185 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9186 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9187 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9188 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9189 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9190 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9191 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9192 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009193
9194 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9195
9196 Example :
9197 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9198 backend https
9199 mode tcp
9200 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009201 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009202 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009203
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009204 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9205 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9206
9207 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9208 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9209 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9210
9211 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9212 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009213
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009214 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9215 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9216 # at offset 44.
9217
9218 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9219 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9220
9221 # Learn on response if server hello.
9222 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009223
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009224 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9225 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9226
9227 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9228 extraction.
9229
9230
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009231tcp-check connect [params*]
9232 Opens a new connection
9233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9234 no | no | yes | yes
9235
9236 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9237 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9238 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9239
9240 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9241 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9242 of the sequence.
9243
9244 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9245 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9246 do.
9247
9248 Parameters :
9249 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9250 use the TCP connection.
9251
9252 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9253 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9254 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9255
9256 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9257
9258 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9259
9260 Examples:
9261 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9262 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9263 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9264 option tcp-check
9265 tcp-check connect
9266 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9267 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9268 tcp-check send \r\n
9269 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9270 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9271 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9272 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9273 tcp-check send \r\n
9274 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9275 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9276
9277 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9278 option tcp-check
9279 tcp-check connect port 110
9280 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9281 tcp-check connect port 143
9282 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9283 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9284
9285 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9286
9287
9288tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009289 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009290 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9291 no | no | yes | yes
9292
9293 Arguments :
9294 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9295 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9296 binary.
9297 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9298 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9299 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9300
9301 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9302 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9303 with the usual backslash ('\').
9304 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009305 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009306 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9307 used upper or lower case.
9308
9309
9310 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9311
9312 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9313 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9314 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9315 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9316 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9317 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9318 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9319 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9320
9321 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9322 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9323 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9324 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9325 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9326 expression.
9327
9328 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9329 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9330 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9331 this exact hexadecimal string.
9332 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9333
9334 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9335 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9336 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9337 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9338 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9339 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9340 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9341 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9342 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9343 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9344 the null character.
9345
9346 Examples :
9347 # perform a POP check
9348 option tcp-check
9349 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9350
9351 # perform an IMAP check
9352 option tcp-check
9353 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9354
9355 # look for the redis master server
9356 option tcp-check
9357 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009358 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009359 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9360 tcp-check expect string role:master
9361 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9362 tcp-check expect string +OK
9363
9364
9365 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9366 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9367
9368
9369tcp-check send <data>
9370 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9371 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9372 no | no | yes | yes
9373
9374 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9375 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9376
9377 Examples :
9378 # look for the redis master server
9379 option tcp-check
9380 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9381 tcp-check expect string role:master
9382
9383 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9384 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9385
9386
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009387tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9388 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009389 tcp health check
9390 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9391 no | no | yes | yes
9392
9393 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9394 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009395 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009396 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9397 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9398 hexadecimal string.
9399 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9400
9401 Examples :
9402 # redis check in binary
9403 option tcp-check
9404 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9405 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9406
9407
9408 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9409 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9410
9411
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009412tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9413 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9415 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009416 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009417 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9418 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009419
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009420 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009421
9422 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9423 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009424 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9425 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9426 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9427 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9428 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9429 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009430
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009431 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9432 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9433 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9434 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009435
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009436 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009437 - accept :
9438 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9439 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9440 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009441
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009442 - reject :
9443 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9444 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9445 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9446 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9447 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9448 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9449 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9450 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9451 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9452 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9453 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009454 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009455
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009456 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9457 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9458 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9459 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9460 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9461 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9462 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9463 hosts.
9464
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009465 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9466 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9467 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9468 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9469 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9470 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9471 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9472 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9473
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009474 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9475 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9476 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9477 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9478 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9479 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9480 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9481 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9482 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009483 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9484 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009485
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009486 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009487 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009488 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9489 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9490 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9491 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9492 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9493 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9494 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9495 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9496 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9497 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9498 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9499 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009500
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009501 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009502 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009503 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009504 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009505 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9506 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9507 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009508
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009509 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9510 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9511 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9512 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009513
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009514 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9515 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9516 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9517 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9518 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009519 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9520 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9521 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9522 layer7 information is extracted.
9523
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009524 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9525 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9526 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9527 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9528 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009529
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009530 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9531 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9532 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9533 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9534
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009535 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9536 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9537 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9538 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9539
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009540 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9541 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9542 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9543 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9544 continues.
9545
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009546 - set-src <expr> :
9547 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9548 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9549 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009550 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009551
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009552 Arguments:
9553 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9554 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009555
9556 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009557 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9558
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009559 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9560 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009561
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009562 - set-src-port <expr> :
9563 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9564 expression.
9565
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009566 Arguments:
9567 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9568 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009569
9570 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009571 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9572
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009573 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9574 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9575 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009576
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009577 - set-dst <expr> :
9578 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9579 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9580 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9581 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9582 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9583
9584 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9585 followed by some converters.
9586
9587 Example:
9588
9589 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9590 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9591
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009592 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9593 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9594
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009595 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9596 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9597 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9598 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9599
9600
9601 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9602 followed by some converters.
9603
9604 Example:
9605
9606 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9607
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009608 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9609 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9610 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9611
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009612 - "silent-drop" :
9613 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009614 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009615 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9616 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9617 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9618 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9619 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009620 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9621 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009622 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9623 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009624 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009625 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9626 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9627 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9628 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9629
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009630 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9631 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9632 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009633
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009634 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9635 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9636 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009637
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009638 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009639 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009640 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009641
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009642 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9643 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9644 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009645
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009646 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009647 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9648 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009649
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009650 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9651
9652 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9653
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009654 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9655
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009656 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009657
9658
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009659tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9660 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009662 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009663 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009664 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9665 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009666
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009667 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009668
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009669 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009670 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9671 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9672 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9673 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009674
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009675 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9676 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9677 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9678 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009679 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9680 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9681 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9682 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9683 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9684 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009685 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009686 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009687
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009688 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9689 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9690 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9691 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009692
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009693 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009694 - accept : the request is accepted
9695 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9696 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009697 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009698 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009699 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009700 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009701 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009702 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009703 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009704 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009705 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009706
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009707 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9708 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009709
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009710 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9711 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9712 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9713 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9714 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9715 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009717 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009718 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9719 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009720
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009721 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009722 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9723 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9724 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9725 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009726 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9727 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9728 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009729
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009730 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009731 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9732 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9733 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009734
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009735 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009736 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9737 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009738
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009739 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9740 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009741 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009742 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9743 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009744 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009745 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009746 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009747 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9748 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009749 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009750 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9751 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009752
9753 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9754 followed by some converters.
9755
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009756 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9757 <var-name>.
9758
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009759 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9760 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9761 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9762 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9763 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9764
9765 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9766 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9767 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9768 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9769 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9770 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9771 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9772 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9773 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9774 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9775 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9776
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009777 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9778 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9779 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9780 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9781 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9782
9783 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9784
9785 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9786
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009787 Example:
9788
9789 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009790 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009791
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009792 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009793 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9794 # and reject everything else.
9795 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9796 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009797 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009798 tcp-request content reject
9799
9800 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009801 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9802 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9803 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009804 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009805
9806 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9807 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9808 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009809 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009810 tcp-request content reject
9811
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009812 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009813 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009814 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009815 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009816 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9817 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009818
9819 Example:
9820 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9821 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009822 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009823
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009824 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009825 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009826
9827 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009828 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009829 # protecting all our sites
9830 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009831 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9832 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009833 ...
9834 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9835
9836 backend http_dynamic
9837 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009838 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009839 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009840 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009841 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009842 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009843 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009845 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009846
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009847 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9848 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009849
9850
9851tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9852 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009854 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009855 Arguments :
9856 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9857 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9858 as explained at the top of this document.
9859
9860 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9861 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9862 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9863 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9864 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9865
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009866 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9867 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9868 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9869 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9870
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009871 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9872 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009873 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009874 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009875 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9876 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9877 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9878 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009879
9880 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9881 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9882 it pass through unaffected.
9883
9884 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9885 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9886 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009887 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009888 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9889 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009890 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9891 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9892 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009893
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009894 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009895 "timeout client".
9896
9897
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009898tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9899 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9901 no | no | yes | yes
9902 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009903 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9904 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009905
9906 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9907
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009908 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009909 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9910 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009911 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9912 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009913
9914 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9915
9916 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9917 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9918 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9919 inserted.
9920
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009921 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009922 - accept :
9923 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9924 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9925 the rules evaluation.
9926
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009927 - close :
9928 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9929 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9930 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9931 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9932 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9933 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009934 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009935 protocols.
9936
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009937 - reject :
9938 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9939 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009940 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009941
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009942 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9943 Sets a variable.
9944
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009945 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9946 Unsets a variable.
9947
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009948 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9949 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9950 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9951 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9952
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009953 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9954 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9955 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9956 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9957
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009958 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9959 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9960 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9961 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9962 continues.
9963
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009964 - "silent-drop" :
9965 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009966 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009967 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9968 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9969 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9970 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9971 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009972 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9973 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009974 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9975 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009976 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009977 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9978 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9979 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9980 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9981
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009982 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9983 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9984
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009985 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9986 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9987 for changing the default action to a reject.
9988
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009989 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9990 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9991 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9992 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009993 period.
9994
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009995 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9996 declared inline.
9997
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009998 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9999 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010000 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010001 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10002 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010003 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010004 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010005 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010006 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10007 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010008 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010009 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10010 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010011
10012 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10013 followed by some converters.
10014
10015 Example:
10016
10017 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10018
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010019 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10020 <var-name>.
10021
10022 Example:
10023
10024 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10025
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010026 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10027 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10028 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10029 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10030 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10031
10032 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10033
10034 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10035
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010036 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10037
10038 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10039
10040
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010041tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10042 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10044 no | yes | yes | no
10045 Arguments :
10046 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10047 below.
10048
10049 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10050
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010051 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010052 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10053 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10054 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10055 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10056 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10057 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10058 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010059 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010060 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10061 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10062 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10063 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10064 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10065 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10066 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10067 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10068 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10069 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10070 instead.
10071
10072 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10073 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10074 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10075 rules which may be inserted.
10076
10077 Several types of actions are supported :
10078 - accept : the request is accepted
10079 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10080 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10081 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010082 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010083 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10084 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010085 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010086 - silent-drop
10087
10088 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10089 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10090 sections for a complete description.
10091
10092 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10093 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10094 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10095
10096 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10097 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10098 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10099 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10100 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10101
10102 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10103 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10104
10105 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10106 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10107 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10108
10109 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10110 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10111 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10112
10113 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10114 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10115 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10116
10117 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10118 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10119 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10120
10121 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10122
10123 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10124
10125
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010126tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10127 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10129 no | no | yes | yes
10130 Arguments :
10131 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10132 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10133 as explained at the top of this document.
10134
10135 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10136
10137
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010138timeout check <timeout>
10139 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10140 established.
10141
10142 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10143 yes | no | yes | yes
10144 Arguments:
10145 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10146 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10147 as explained at the top of this document.
10148
10149 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10150 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010151 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010152 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010153 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10154 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10155 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010156
10157 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10158 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10159
10160 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10161 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010162 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010163
10164 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10165 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10166 forget about it.
10167
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010168 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10169 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010170
10171
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010172timeout client <timeout>
10173timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10174 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10176 yes | yes | yes | no
10177 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010178 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010179 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10180 as explained at the top of this document.
10181
10182 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10183 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10184 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010185 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10186 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10187 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10188 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010189 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10190 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10191 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010192 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010193 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010194 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10195 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010196 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10197 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010198
10199 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10200 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10201 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10202 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10203 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10204 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10205
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010206 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010207
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010208 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10209 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10210 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10211
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010212 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10213 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010214
10215
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010216timeout client-fin <timeout>
10217 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10219 yes | yes | yes | no
10220 Arguments :
10221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10223 as explained at the top of this document.
10224
10225 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10226 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10227 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10228 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10229 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10230 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10231 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010232 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10233 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10234 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010235
10236 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10237 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10238 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10239
10240 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10241
10242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010243timeout connect <timeout>
10244timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10245 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10247 yes | no | yes | yes
10248 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010249 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010250 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10251 as explained at the top of this document.
10252
10253 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010254 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010255 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010256 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010257 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10258 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010259
10260 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10261 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10262 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10263 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10264 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10265 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10266
10267 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10268 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10269 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10270
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010271 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10272 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010273
10274
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010275timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10276 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10278 yes | yes | yes | yes
10279 Arguments :
10280 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10281 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10282 as explained at the top of this document.
10283
10284 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10285 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10286 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10287 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10288 once the request has started to present itself.
10289
10290 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10291 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10292 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10293 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10294 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10295
10296 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10297 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10298 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10299 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10300
10301 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10302 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010303 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010304 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10305 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010306 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010307
10308 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10309 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10310 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10311 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10312
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010313 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10314 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010315 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10316
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010317 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10318
10319
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010320timeout http-request <timeout>
10321 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010323 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010324 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010325 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010326 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10327 as explained at the top of this document.
10328
10329 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10330 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10331 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10332 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10333 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10334 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10335 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010336 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10337 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10338 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10339 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010340 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010341 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10342 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010343
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010344 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10345 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10346 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10347 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10348 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010349 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010350
10351 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10352 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010353 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010354 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10355 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10356
10357 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010358 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10359 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10360 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010361
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010362 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010363 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010364
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010365
10366timeout queue <timeout>
10367 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10369 yes | no | yes | yes
10370 Arguments :
10371 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10372 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10373 as explained at the top of this document.
10374
10375 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10376 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10377 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10378 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10379 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10380
10381 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10382 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10383 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10384 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10385
10386 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10387
10388
10389timeout server <timeout>
10390timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10391 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10393 yes | no | yes | yes
10394 Arguments :
10395 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10396 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10397 as explained at the top of this document.
10398
10399 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10400 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10401 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10402 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10403 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10404 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10405 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10406
10407 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10408 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10409 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10410 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10411 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010412 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010413 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010414 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10415 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010416 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10417 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010418
10419 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10420 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10421 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10422 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10423 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10424 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10425
10426 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10427 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10428 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10429
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010430 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010431
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010432
10433timeout server-fin <timeout>
10434 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10436 yes | no | yes | yes
10437 Arguments :
10438 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10439 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10440 as explained at the top of this document.
10441
10442 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10443 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10444 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10445 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10446 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10447 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10448 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10449 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10450 situations, it should not be needed.
10451
10452 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10453 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10454 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10455
10456 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10457
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010458
10459timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010460 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10462 yes | yes | yes | yes
10463 Arguments :
10464 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10465 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10466 as explained at the top of this document.
10467
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010468 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10469 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10470 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10471 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010472
10473 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10474 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10475 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10476 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010477 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010478
10479 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10480
10481
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010482timeout tunnel <timeout>
10483 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10485 yes | no | yes | yes
10486 Arguments :
10487 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10488 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10489 as explained at the top of this document.
10490
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010491 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010492 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10493 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10494 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010495 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10496 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010497 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10498 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10499 specified.
10500
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010501 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10502 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10503 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10504 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10505 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10506 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10507 state.
10508
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010509 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10510 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10511 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10512 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010513 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010514
10515 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10516 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10517 forget about it.
10518
10519 Example :
10520 defaults http
10521 option http-server-close
10522 timeout connect 5s
10523 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010524 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010525 timeout server 30s
10526 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10527
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010528 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010529
10530
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010531transparent (deprecated)
10532 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010534 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010535 Arguments : none
10536
10537 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10538 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10539 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10540 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10541 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10542 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10543 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10544 appropriate server.
10545
10546 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10547
10548 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10549 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10550
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010551 See also: "option transparent"
10552
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010553unique-id-format <string>
10554 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10556 yes | yes | yes | no
10557 Arguments :
10558 <string> is a log-format string.
10559
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010560 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10561 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10562 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10563 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010564
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010565 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10566 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10567 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10568 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10569 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10570 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10571 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10572 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010573
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010574 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10575 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010576
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010577 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010578
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010579 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010580
10581 will generate:
10582
10583 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10584
10585 See also: "unique-id-header"
10586
10587unique-id-header <name>
10588 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10590 yes | yes | yes | no
10591 Arguments :
10592 <name> is the name of the header.
10593
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010594 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10595 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010596
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010597 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010598
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010599 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010600 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10601
10602 will generate:
10603
10604 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10605
10606 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010607
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010608use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010609 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10611 no | yes | yes | no
10612 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010613 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10614 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010615
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010616 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10617 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010618
10619 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10620 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10621 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010622 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010623 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010624 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10625 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010626
10627 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10628 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10629 assign the backend.
10630
10631 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10632 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10633 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10634 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10635 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10636 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10637
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010638 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010639 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010640 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10641 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10642 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10643
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010644 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10645 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10646 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10647 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10648 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10649 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10650 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10651 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10652 cannot be forced from the request.
10653
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010654 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010655 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10656 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10657
10658 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10659 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010660
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010661
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010662use-server <server> if <condition>
10663use-server <server> unless <condition>
10664 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10666 no | no | yes | yes
10667 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010668 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010669
10670 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10671
10672 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10673 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10674 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10675
10676 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10677 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10678 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10679 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10680 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10681 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10682 matches will assign the server.
10683
10684 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10685 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10686 with the next rules until one matches.
10687
10688 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10689 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10690 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10691 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10692
10693 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10694 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10695 stripped.
10696
10697 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10698 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10699 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10700 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10701
10702 Example :
10703 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10704 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10705 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10706 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10707 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10708 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010709 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010710 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10711 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10712
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010713 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010714
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010715
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107165. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010717--------------------------
10718
10719The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10720depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10721settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10722written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10723described in this section.
10724
10725
107265.1. Bind options
10727-----------------
10728
10729The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10730as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10731no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10732parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10733while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10734provided immediately after the setting name.
10735
10736The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10737
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010738accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10739 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10740 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10741 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10742 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10743 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10744 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10745 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10746 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10747 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010748 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10749 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10750 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010751
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010752accept-proxy
10753 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010754 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10755 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010756 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10757 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10758 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10759 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010760 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010761 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10762 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010763 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10764 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010765
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010766allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010767 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010768 due to security considerations.
10769
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010770alpn <protocols>
10771 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10772 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10773 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10774 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10775 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010776 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10777 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10778 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10779 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10780 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10781 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10782 preference, like below :
10783
10784 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010785
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010786backlog <backlog>
10787 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10788 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10789
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010790curves <curves>
10791 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10792 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10793 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10794 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10795 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10796 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10797
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010798ecdhe <named curve>
10799 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010800 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10801 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010802
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010803ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10805 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10806 client's certificate.
10807
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010808ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10810 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10811 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10812 error is ignored.
10813
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010814ca-sign-file <cafile>
10815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10816 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10817 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10818 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10819 'generate-certificates' for details.
10820
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010821ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10823 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10824 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10825 'generate-certificates' for details.
10826
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010827ciphers <ciphers>
10828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10829 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010830 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3. The format of the
10831 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for
10832 instance a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without
10833 quotes). Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list
10834 of suitable ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background
10835 information and recommendations see e.g.
10836 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10837 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10838 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10839
10840ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10842 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10843 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10844 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
10845 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section, and can be for instance a
10846 string such as
10847 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
10848 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
10849 the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010850
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010851crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10853 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10854 to verify client's certificate.
10855
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010856crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010857 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10858 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10859 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10860 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10861 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10862 file.
10863
10864 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10865 are loaded.
10866
10867 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010868 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010869 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10870 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10871 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10872 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010873 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10874 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010875 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010876
10877 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10878 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10879 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10880 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010881 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10882 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010883
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010884 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010885
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010886 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010887 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010888 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10889 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010890 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10891 clients).
10892
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010893 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10894 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10895 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10896 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10897 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10898 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10899 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10900 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10901 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10902 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10903 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10904 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10905 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10906
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010907 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10908 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10909 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10910 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10911 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10912
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010913 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10914 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10915 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10916 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010917
10918 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10919 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10920 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10921 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10922 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10923 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10924 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10925 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10926 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10927
10928 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10929
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010930 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010931 a cert bundle.
10932
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010933 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010934 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10935 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10936 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10937 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10938 provide multi-cert support.
10939
10940 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10941
10942 Filename | CN | SAN
10943 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10944 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010945 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010946 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10947 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10948
10949 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10950 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10951 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10952 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010953 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10954 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10955 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010956
10957 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10958 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10959
10960 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10961 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10962 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10963
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010964crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010965 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010966 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010967 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010968 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010969
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010970crt-list <file>
10971 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010972 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10973 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010974
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010975 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10976
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010977 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10978 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010979 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010980 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010981
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010982 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10983 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10984 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10985 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10986 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10987 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10988 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10989 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010990
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010991 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010992 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010993 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10994 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10995 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010996
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010997 crt-list file example:
10998 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010999 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011000 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011001 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011002
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011003defer-accept
11004 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11005 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11006 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011007 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011008 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11009 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11010 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11011 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11012 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11013 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11014 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11015
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011016expose-fd listeners
11017 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11018 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011019 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11020 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011021 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011022
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011023force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011024 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011025 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011026 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011027 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011028
11029force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011030 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011031 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011032 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011033
11034force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011035 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011036 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011037 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011038
11039force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011040 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011041 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011042 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011043
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011044force-tlsv13
11045 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11046 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011047 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011048
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011049generate-certificates
11050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11051 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11052 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11053 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11054 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11055 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11056 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11057 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11058 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11059 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11060 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11061
11062 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11063 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011064 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011065 certificate is used many times.
11066
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011067gid <gid>
11068 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11069 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11070 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11071 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11072 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11073
11074group <group>
11075 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11076 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11077 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11078 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11079 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11080
11081id <id>
11082 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11083 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11084 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11085 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11086
11087interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011088 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11089 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11090 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11091 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11092 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11093 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011094 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11095 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11096 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11097 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11098 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11099 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011100
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011101level <level>
11102 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11103 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11104 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011105 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011106 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11107 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11108 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011109 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011110 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011111 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011112 all counters).
11113
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011114severity-output <format>
11115 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11116 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11117 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11118 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11119 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11120 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11121 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11122 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11123 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11124 rfc5424 convention.
11125
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011126maxconn <maxconn>
11127 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11128 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11129 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11130 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11131 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11132 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11133 eat all memory.
11134
11135mode <mode>
11136 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11137 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11138 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11139 UNIX sockets.
11140
11141mss <maxseg>
11142 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11143 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11144 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11145 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11146 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11147 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11148 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11149 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11150 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11151 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11152 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11153
11154name <name>
11155 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11156 page.
11157
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011158namespace <name>
11159 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11160 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11161 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11162 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11163
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011164nice <nice>
11165 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11166 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11167 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11168 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11169 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11170 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11171 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11172 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11173 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11174 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11175 one for an RDP socket.
11176
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011177no-ca-names
11178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11179 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11180
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011181no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011183 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011184 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011185 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011186 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11187 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011188
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011189no-tls-tickets
11190 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11191 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11192 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011193 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11194 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011195
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011196no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011197 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011198 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011199 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011200 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011201 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11202 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011203
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011204no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011205 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011206 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011207 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011208 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011209 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11210 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011211
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011212no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011213 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011214 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011215 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011216 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011217 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11218 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011219
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011220no-tlsv13
11221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11222 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11223 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11224 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011225 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11226 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011227
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011228npn <protocols>
11229 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11230 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11231 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11232 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011233 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011234 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11235 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11236 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11237 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11238 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011239
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011240prefer-client-ciphers
11241 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11242 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11243 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011244 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11245 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11246 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011247
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011248process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11249 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11250 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011251 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011252 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11253 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11254 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11255 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011256 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011257 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11258 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11259 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11260
11261 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11262
11263 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11264 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11265 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11266 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11267 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11268 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11269 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11270 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011271
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011272proto <name>
11273 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11274 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11275 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11276 in haproxy -vv.
11277 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11278 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011279 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011280 h2" on the bind line.
11281
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011282ssl
11283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011284 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011285 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11286 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011287 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11288 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011289
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011290ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11291 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11292 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11293 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11294
11295ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11296 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11297 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11298 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11299
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011300strict-sni
11301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11302 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11303 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11304 See the "crt" option for more information.
11305
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011306tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011307 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011308 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11309 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011310 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011311 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11312 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11313 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11314 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11315 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11316 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11317 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11318
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011319tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011320 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011321 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11322 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11323 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11324 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11325 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11326 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11327 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011328 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11329 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11330 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011331
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011332tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11333 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
11334 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
11335 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
11336 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
11337 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
11338 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
11339 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
11340 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
11341 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11342 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11343
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011344transparent
11345 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11346 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11347 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11348 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11349 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11350 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11351 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11352 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11353 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11354 so check for support with your vendor.
11355
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011356v4v6
11357 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11358 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11359 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11360 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011361 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011362
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011363v6only
11364 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11365 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11366 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011367 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11368 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011369
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011370uid <uid>
11371 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11372 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11373 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11374 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11375 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11376
11377user <user>
11378 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11379 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11380 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11381 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11382 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11383
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011384verify [none|optional|required]
11385 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11386 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11387 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11388 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11389 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011390 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11391 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11392 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11393 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011394
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200113955.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011396------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011398The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11399which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11400arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11401settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11402after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11403Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11404address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011406 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011407 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011408
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011409Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11410keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011412The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011413
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011414addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011415 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011416 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11417 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11418 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11419 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11420 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011421
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011422agent-check
11423 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011424 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11425 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11426 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11427 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011428
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011429 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011430 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011431 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11432 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11433 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011434
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011435 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11436 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11437 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11438 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11439 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011440
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011441 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011442 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011443
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011444 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11445 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11446 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011447
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011448 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11449 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11450 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011451
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011452 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11453 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11454 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11455 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11456 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011457 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011458 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011459
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011460 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11461 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011462
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011463 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11464 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11465 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11466 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11467 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11468 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11469 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11470 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11471 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011472
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011473 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11474 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011475 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11476 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11477 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011478 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011479
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011480 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011481 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011482
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011483agent-send <string>
11484 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11485 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11486 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11487 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11488 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11489
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011490agent-inter <delay>
11491 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11492 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11493
11494 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11495 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11496 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11497 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11498 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11499 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11500 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11501 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11502 of backends use the same servers.
11503
11504 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11505
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011506agent-addr <addr>
11507 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11508
11509 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11510 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11511 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11512 hostname, it will be resolved.
11513
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011514agent-port <port>
11515 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11516
11517 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11518
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011519alpn <protocols>
11520 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11521 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11522 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11523 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11524 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11525 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11526 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11527 now obsolete NPN extension.
11528 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11529 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11530
11531 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011533backup
11534 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11535 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11536 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11537 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011538 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11539 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011540
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011541ca-file <cafile>
11542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11543 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11544 server's certificate.
11545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011546check
11547 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011548 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11549 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11550 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11551 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11552 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11553 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11554 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011555 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11556 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011557 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11558 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011559
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011560check-send-proxy
11561 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11562 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11563 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11564 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11565 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11566 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11567 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11568
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011569check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011570 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011571 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11572 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011573
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011574check-ssl
11575 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11576 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11577 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11578 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011579 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011580 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11581 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011582 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011583 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11584 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011585
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011586ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011587 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11588 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11589 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011590 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11591 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11592 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11593 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11594 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11595 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11596
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011597ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11599 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11600 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11601 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
11602 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section.
11603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011604cookie <value>
11605 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11606 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11607 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11608 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11609 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11610 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11611 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11612
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011613crl-file <crlfile>
11614 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11615 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11616 to verify server's certificate.
11617
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011618crt <cert>
11619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11620 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11621 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11622 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11623 certificate request.
11624
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011625disabled
11626 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11627 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11628 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11629 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11630 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011631 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011632
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011633enabled
11634 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11635 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11636 default value.
11637 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11638 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011639
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011640error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011641 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11642 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11643 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011645 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011646
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011647fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011648 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11649 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11650 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11651
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011652force-sslv3
11653 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11654 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011655 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011656 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011657
11658force-tlsv10
11659 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011660 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011661 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011662
11663force-tlsv11
11664 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011665 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011666 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011667
11668force-tlsv12
11669 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011670 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011671 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011672
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011673force-tlsv13
11674 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11675 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011676 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011678id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011679 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11680 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11681 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011682
Olivier Houchard0c18a6f2018-12-02 14:11:41 +010011683idle-timeout <delay>
11684 Set the time to keep a connection alive before destroying it. By default
11685 connections are destroyed as soon as they are unused, if idle-timeout is
11686 non-zero, then connection are kept alive for up to <delay> before being
11687 destroyed, and can be reused if no other connection is available.
11688
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011689init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11690 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11691 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011692 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011693 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11694 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11695 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11696 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11697 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11698 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11699 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11700 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11701 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011702 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011703 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11704 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11705 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11706 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11707 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11708 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011709 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011710
11711 Example:
11712 defaults
11713 # never fail on address resolution
11714 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011716inter <delay>
11717fastinter <delay>
11718downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011719 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11720 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11721 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11722 between checks depending on the server state :
11723
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011724 Server state | Interval used
11725 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11726 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11727 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11728 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11729 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11730 or yet unchecked. |
11731 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11732 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11733 | "inter" otherwise.
11734 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011736 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11737 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11738 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11739 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011740 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11741 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11742 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11743 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11744 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011746maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011747 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11748 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11749 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11750 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11751 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11752 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11753 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11754 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011756maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011757 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11758 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11759 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11760 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11761 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11762 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11763 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011765minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011766 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11767 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11768 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11769 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11770 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11771 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011772 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011773 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011774
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011775namespace <name>
11776 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11777 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11778 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11779 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11780
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011781no-agent-check
11782 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11783 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11784 default value.
11785 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11786 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11787
11788no-backup
11789 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11790 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11791 default value.
11792 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11793 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11794
11795no-check
11796 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11797 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11798 default value.
11799 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11800 "default-server" "check" setting.
11801
11802no-check-ssl
11803 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11804 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11805 default value.
11806 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11807 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11808
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011809no-send-proxy
11810 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11811 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11812 default value.
11813 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11814 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11815
11816no-send-proxy-v2
11817 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11818 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11819 default value.
11820 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11821 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11822
11823no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11824 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11825 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11826 default value.
11827 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11828 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11829
11830no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11831 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11832 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11833 default value.
11834 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11835 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11836
11837no-ssl
11838 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11839 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11840 default value.
11841 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11842 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11843
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011844no-ssl-reuse
11845 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11846 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11847 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11848 and for paranoid users.
11849
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011850no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011851 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11852 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011853 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011854
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011855 Supported in default-server: No
11856
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011857no-tls-tickets
11858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11859 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11860 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011861 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11862 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011863 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011864
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011865no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011866 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011867 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11868 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011869 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11870 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011871 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011872
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011873 Supported in default-server: No
11874
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011875no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011876 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011877 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11878 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011879 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11880 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011881 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011882
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011883 Supported in default-server: No
11884
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011885no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011886 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011887 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11888 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011889 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11890 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011891 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011892
11893 Supported in default-server: No
11894
11895no-tlsv13
11896 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11897 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11898 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11899 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11900 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011901 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011902
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011903 Supported in default-server: No
11904
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011905no-verifyhost
11906 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11907 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11908 default value.
11909 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11910 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011911
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011912non-stick
11913 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11914 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11915 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11916
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011917npn <protocols>
11918 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11919 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11920 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11921 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11922 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11923 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11924 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11925
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011926observe <mode>
11927 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11928 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11929 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11930 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11931 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11932 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011933 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011934
11935 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11936
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011937on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011938 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11939 Currently, four modes are available:
11940 - fastinter: force fastinter
11941 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11942 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11943 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11944 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11945
11946 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11947
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011948on-marked-down <action>
11949 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11950 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011951 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11952 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11953 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11954 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11955 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11956 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11957 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11958 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011959
11960 Actions are disabled by default
11961
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011962on-marked-up <action>
11963 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11964 Currently one action is available:
11965 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11966 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11967 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11968 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011969 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11970 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011971 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11972 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11973
11974 Actions are disabled by default
11975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011976port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011977 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11978 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11979 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11980 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11981 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11982 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11983
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011984proto <name>
11985
11986 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11987 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11988 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11989 reported in haproxy -vv.
11990 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11991 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011993redir <prefix>
11994 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11995 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11996 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11997 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11998 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11999 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12000 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12001 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012002 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012003 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012004 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12005 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12006 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12007 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12008
12009 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012011rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012012 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12013 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12014 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12015
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012016resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12017 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12018 server.
12019
12020 Available options:
12021
12022 * allow-dup-ip
12023 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12024 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12025 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12026 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12027 For such case, simply enable this option.
12028 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12029
12030 * prevent-dup-ip
12031 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12032 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12033 same fqdn.
12034 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12035
12036 Example:
12037 backend b_myapp
12038 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12039 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12040 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12041
12042 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12043 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12044 it
12045 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12046 different address
12047
12048 Default value: not set
12049
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012050resolve-prefer <family>
12051 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12052 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12053 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12054 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12055
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012056 Default value: ipv6
12057
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012058 Example:
12059
12060 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012061
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012062resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12063 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12064 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012065 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012066 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12067 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012068 configured network, another address is selected.
12069
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012070 Example:
12071
12072 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012073
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012074resolvers <id>
12075 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12076 hostname.
12077
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012078 Example:
12079
12080 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012081
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012082 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012083
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012084send-proxy
12085 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12086 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12087 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12088 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012089 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12090 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12091 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12092 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12093 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12094 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12095 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12096 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12097 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12098 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012099 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12100 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012101
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012102send-proxy-v2
12103 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12104 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12105 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12106 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012107 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12108 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12109 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12110 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012111
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012112proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12113 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12114 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012115 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12116 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012117 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12118 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012119 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012120
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012121send-proxy-v2-ssl
12122 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12123 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12124 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12125 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12126 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12127 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12128 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012129 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12130 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012131
12132send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12133 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12134 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12135 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12136 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12137 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12138 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12139 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12140 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012141 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12142 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012144slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012145 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12146 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12147 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12148 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12149 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12150 parameters :
12151
12152 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12153 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12154
12155 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12156 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12157 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12158 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12159
12160 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12161 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12162 seen as failed.
12163
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012164sni <expression>
12165 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12166 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12167 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12168 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012169 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12170 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012171 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012172 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12173 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012174
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012175source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012176source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012177source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012178 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12179 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12180 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12181 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12182
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012183 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12184 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12185 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12186 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12187 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12188 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12189 server.
12190
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012191 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12192 specifying the source address without port(s).
12193
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012194ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012195 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12196 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12197 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12198 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12199 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12200 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012201 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12202 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012203
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012204ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12205 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12206 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12207 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12208
12209ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12210 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12211 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12212 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12213
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012214ssl-reuse
12215 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12216 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12217 default value.
12218 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12219 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12220
12221stick
12222 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12223 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12224 default value.
12225 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12226 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012227
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012228tcp-ut <delay>
12229 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12230 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12231 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012232 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012233 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12234 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12235 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12236 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12237 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12238 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12239 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12240 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12241 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012243track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012244 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12245 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12246 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12247 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012248 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12249
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012250tls-tickets
12251 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12252 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12253 default value.
12254 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12255 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012256
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012257verify [none|required]
12258 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012259 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012260 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12261 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012262 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012263 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12264 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12265 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12266 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12267 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12268 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12269 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12270 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012271
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012272verifyhost <hostname>
12273 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012274 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12275 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12276 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12277 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12278 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12279 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12280 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12281 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012283weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012284 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12285 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12286 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012287 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12288 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12289 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12290 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12291 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12292 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012293
12294
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122955.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12296-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012297
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012298HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12299using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12300configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012301This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12302can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12303workload.
12304This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12305resolution at run time.
12306Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12307carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12308
12309
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123105.3.1. Global overview
12311----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012312
12313As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12314different steps of the process life:
12315
12316 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12317 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12318 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12319
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012320 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12321 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012322
12323A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12324 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12325 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12326 resolution to know this new IP.
12327
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012328When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012329HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012330SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12331from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12332will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12333will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012334
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012335A few things important to notice:
12336 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12337 first valid response.
12338
12339 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12340 servers return an error.
12341
12342
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123435.3.2. The resolvers section
12344----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012345
12346This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012347HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12348contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012349
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012350When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12351uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12352is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12353answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12354
12355When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012356used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012357
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012358 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12359 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12360 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012361
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012362 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12363 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012364
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012365 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12366 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12367 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012368
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012369For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12370following scenarios are possible:
12371
12372 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12373 ignored
12374
12375 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12376 applied
12377
12378 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12379 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12380
12381 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12382 retries the query with a new type
12383
12384 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12385 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012386
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012387As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12388a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012389<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012390
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012391
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012392resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012393 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012394
12395A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12396
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012397accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012398 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012399 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012400 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12401 by RFC 6891)
12402
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012403 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12404
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012405nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12406 DNS server description:
12407 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12408 <ip> : IP address of the server
12409 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12410
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012411parse-resolv-conf
12412 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12413 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12414 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12415
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012416hold <status> <period>
12417 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12418 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012419 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012420 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012421 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12422 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12423 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12424
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012425 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012426
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012427resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012428 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12429 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12430 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12431
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012432resolve_retries <nb>
12433 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12434 giving up.
12435 Default value: 3
12436
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012437 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12438 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12439 type.
12440
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012441timeout <event> <time>
12442 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12443 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12444 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012445 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12446 other time applied.
12447 Default value: 1s
12448 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12449 have been received.
12450 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012451 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12452 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12453
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012454 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012455
12456 resolvers mydns
12457 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12458 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012459 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012460 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012461 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012462 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012463 hold other 30s
12464 hold refused 30s
12465 hold nx 30s
12466 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012467 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012468 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012469
12470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124716. HTTP header manipulation
12472---------------------------
12473
12474In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12475response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12476request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12477which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012478against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012479
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012480If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12481to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12482but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12483HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12484stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12485because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12486a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12487still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012489This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12490in section 4.2 :
12491
12492 - reqadd <string>
12493 - reqallow <search>
12494 - reqiallow <search>
12495 - reqdel <search>
12496 - reqidel <search>
12497 - reqdeny <search>
12498 - reqideny <search>
12499 - reqpass <search>
12500 - reqipass <search>
12501 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12502 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12503 - reqtarpit <search>
12504 - reqitarpit <search>
12505 - rspadd <string>
12506 - rspdel <search>
12507 - rspidel <search>
12508 - rspdeny <search>
12509 - rspideny <search>
12510 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12511 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12512
12513With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12514is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12515parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12516prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12517Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12518
12519 \t for a tab
12520 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12521 \n for a new line (LF)
12522 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12523 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12524 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12525 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12526 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12527
12528The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12529portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12530above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12531regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
125329 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12533is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12534
12535The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12536after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12537
12538Notes related to these keywords :
12539---------------------------------
12540 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12541 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12542 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12543
12544 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12545 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12546 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12547
12548 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12549 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12550 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12551 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12552 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12553
12554 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12555 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12556 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12557 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12558 useless headers before adding new ones.
12559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012560 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012561 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12562
12563 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12564 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12565 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12566
12567 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12568 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012569 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012570
12571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125727. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12573----------------------------------
12574
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012575HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012576client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12577The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12578these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12579but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12580data called patterns.
12581
12582
125837.1. ACL basics
12584---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012585
12586The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12587content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12588from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12589simple :
12590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012591 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012592 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012593 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12594 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012596The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12597adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012598
12599In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012601 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012602
12603This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12604Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12605and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012606an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12607conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12608as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12609are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012610
12611ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12612'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12613which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12614
12615There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12616performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012618The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12619specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12620this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012621methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12622ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012623
12624Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12625 - boolean
12626 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12627 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12628 - string
12629 - data block
12630
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012631Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12632converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12633would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12634The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12635which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12636
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012637Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12638keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12639fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12640which are summarized in the table below :
12641
12642 +---------------------+-----------------+
12643 | Sample or converter | Default |
12644 | output type | matching method |
12645 +---------------------+-----------------+
12646 | boolean | bool |
12647 +---------------------+-----------------+
12648 | integer | int |
12649 +---------------------+-----------------+
12650 | ip | ip |
12651 +---------------------+-----------------+
12652 | string | str |
12653 +---------------------+-----------------+
12654 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12655 +---------------------+-----------------+
12656
12657Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12658matching method, see below.
12659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012660The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12661 - boolean
12662 - integer or integer range
12663 - IP address / network
12664 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12665 - regular expression
12666 - hex block
12667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012668The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12669
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012670 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12671 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012672 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012673 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012674 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012675 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012676 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012678The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12679read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12680if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12681lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12682will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12683beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12684a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12685lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12686exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12687
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012688The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12689parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12690ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12691a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12692check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12693
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012694The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12695socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12696file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012698Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12699loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12700
12701 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12702
12703In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12704the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12705case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12706as well.
12707
12708The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12709sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12710do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12711methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12712is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012713obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012714followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12715default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12716that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12717string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12718
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012719The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12720By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12721string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12722resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12723server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12724waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12725flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12726function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012728There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12729sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12730be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012731
12732 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12733 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012734 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12735 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12736 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12737 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012738
12739 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12740 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012741 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012742
12743 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012744 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012745
12746 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012747 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012748
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012749 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012750 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12751
12752 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12753 binary or string samples.
12754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012755 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12756 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012758 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12759 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12760 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012762 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12763 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012765 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12766 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012768 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12769 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012771 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12772 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012773 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012775 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12776 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12777 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012778
12779For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12780request, it is possible to do :
12781
12782 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12783
12784In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12785buffer, one would use the following acl :
12786
12787 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12788
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012789On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12790possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12791
12792 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012794All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12795criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12796method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12797to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12798criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12799the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012801If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012802the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12803For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012805 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12806 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12807 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12808 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012809
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012810
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012811The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12812types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12813combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12814brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12815default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012817 +-------------------------------------------------+
12818 | Input sample type |
12819 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012820 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12822 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12823 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012824 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012825 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012826 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012827 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012828 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012829 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012830 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012831 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012832 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012834 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012835 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012836 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012838 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012839 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012840 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012841 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012842 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012843 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012844 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012845 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12846 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12847 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012848
12849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128507.1.1. Matching booleans
12851------------------------
12852
12853In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12854Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12855When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12856that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12857
12858Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12859return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12860"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12861
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128637.1.2. Matching integers
12864------------------------
12865
12866Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12867enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12868to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12869
12870Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12871matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12872lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012873
12874For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12875unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12876representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12877
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012878As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12879two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12880instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12881ranges and operators.
12882
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012883For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012884operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12885Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12886of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012887
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012888Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012889
12890 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12891 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12892 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12893 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12894 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012896For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012897
12898 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12899
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012900This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12901
12902 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12903
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129057.1.3. Matching strings
12906-----------------------
12907
12908String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12909different forms :
12910
12911 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012912 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012913
12914 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012915 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012916
12917 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12918 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12919
12920 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12921 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12922
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012923 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012924 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12925 matches.
12926
12927 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12928 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12929 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012930
12931String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12932exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12933characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12934string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12935to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012936before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012937
12938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129397.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12940---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012941
12942Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12943they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12944possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12945passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12946the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012947the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12948match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012949
12950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129517.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12952-------------------------------------
12953
12954It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12955not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12956a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12957to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12958digits may be used upper or lower case.
12959
12960Example :
12961 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12962 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12963
12964
129657.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12966---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012967
12968IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12969netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12970within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012971host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012972difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12973at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12974does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12975parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012976
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012977The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12978abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12979
12980 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12981 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12982 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12983 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12984 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12985 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12986 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12987 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12988
12989Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12990192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12991
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012992IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12993Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12994trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12995IPv6 patterns.
12996
12997HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12998following situations :
12999 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13000 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13001 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13002 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13003 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13004 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13005 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13006 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13007 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13008 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013010
130117.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13012----------------------------------
13013
13014Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13015combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13016
13017 - AND (implicit)
13018 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13019 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013021A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013023 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013025Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13026indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013028For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13029"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13030requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13031is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13032
13033 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013034 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13035 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13036 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013037
13038To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13039and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13040
13041 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13042 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13043 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13044 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13045
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013046 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013047 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13048 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13049 use_backend www if host_www
13050
13051It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13052expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13053be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13054the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13055
13056 The following rule :
13057
13058 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013059 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060
13061 Can also be written that way :
13062
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013063 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013064
13065It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13066to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13067simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13068sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13069good use is the following :
13070
13071 With named ACLs :
13072
13073 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13074 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13075 monitor fail if site_dead
13076
13077 With anonymous ACLs :
13078
13079 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13080
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013081See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13082keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013083
13084
130857.3. Fetching samples
13086---------------------
13087
13088Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13089against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13090sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13091ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13092of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13093available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13094
13095This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13096Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13097compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13098deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13099
13100The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13101matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13102method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13103indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13104
13105As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13106when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13107mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13108the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13109ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13110
13111Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13112multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13113when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013114incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13115are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013116is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13117all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13118
13119Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13120 - name
13121 - name(arg1)
13122 - name(arg1,arg2)
13123
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013124
131257.3.1. Converters
13126-----------------
13127
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013128Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13129of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13130is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13131was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013132has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013133unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13134
13135These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13136sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13137the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013138support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013139
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013140A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13141support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13142supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13143(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13144bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013146The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013147
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001314851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13149 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13150 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13151 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13152 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13153 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13154
13155 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013156 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13157 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013158 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13159 frontend http-in
13160 bind *:8081
13161 default_backend servers
13162 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13163 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13164
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013165add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013166 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013167 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013168 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13169 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013170 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013171 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13172 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13173 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13174 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013175 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013176 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013177
13178and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013179 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013180 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013181 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13182 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013183 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013184 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13185 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13186 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13187 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013188 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013189 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013190
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013191b64dec
13192 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13193 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13194
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013195base64
13196 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013197 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013198 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13199
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013200bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013201 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013202 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013203 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013204 presence of a flag).
13205
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013206bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13207 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13208 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013209 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013210
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013211concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13212 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13213 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13214 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13215 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13216 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13217 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13218 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13219 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13220 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13221 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13222 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13223 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13224 delimitors.
13225
13226 Example:
13227 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13228 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13229 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13230 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13231
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013232cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013233 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13234 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013235
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013236crc32([<avalanche>])
13237 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13238 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13239 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13240 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13241 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13242 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13243 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13244 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13245 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13246 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013247 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13248
13249crc32c([<avalanche>])
13250 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13251 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13252 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13253 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13254 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13255 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13256 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13257 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013258
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013259da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013260 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13261 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13262 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13263 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013264 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013265 configuration language.
13266
13267 Example:
13268 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013269 bind *:8881
13270 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013271 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013272
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013273debug
13274 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13275 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13276 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13277
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013278div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013279 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13280 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013281 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013282 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13283 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013284 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013285 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13286 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13287 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13288 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013289 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013290 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013291
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013292djb2([<avalanche>])
13293 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13294 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13295 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13296 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13297 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13298 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13299 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013300 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13301 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013302
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013303even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013304 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013305 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13306
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013307field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13308 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13309 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13310 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13311 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13312 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13313 fields.
13314
13315 Example :
13316 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13317 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13318 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13319 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13320 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013321
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013322hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013323 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013324 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013325 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013326 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013327
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013328hex2i
13329 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13330 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13331
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013332http_date([<offset>])
13333 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13334 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13335 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13336 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13337 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13338 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013339
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013340in_table(<table>)
13341 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13342 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13343 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013344 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013345 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13346
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013347ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13348 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013349 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013350 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13351 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13352 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13353 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13354 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013355
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013356json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013357 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013358 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013359 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013360 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13361 of errors:
13362 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13363 bytes, ...)
13364 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13365 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13366
13367 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13368 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13369 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13370 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13371 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13372 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013373 - "ascii" : never fails;
13374 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13375 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013376 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013377 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013378 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13379 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13380
13381 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013382 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013383
13384 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013385 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013386 capture request header user-agent len 150
13387 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013388
13389 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13390 GET / HTTP/1.0
13391 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13392
13393 Output log:
13394 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13395
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013396language(<value>[,<default>])
13397 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13398 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13399 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13400 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13401 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13402 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13403 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13404 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13405 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013406 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013407 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13408 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013409
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013410 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013411
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013412 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13413 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013414
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013415 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13416 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13417 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13418 use_backend spanish if es
13419 use_backend french if fr
13420 use_backend english if en
13421 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013422
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013423length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013424 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13425 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13426 type. The result is of type integer.
13427
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013428lower
13429 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13430 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13431 type. The result is of type string.
13432
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013433ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13434 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13435 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13436 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13437 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13438 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13439 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13440
13441 Example :
13442
13443 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013444 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013445 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13446
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013447map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13448map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13449map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13450 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13451 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13452 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13453 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13454 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13455 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13456 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13457 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013458
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013459 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13460 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13461 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013462
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013463 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013464 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013465
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013466 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13467 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13468 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13469 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013470 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13471 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013472 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13473 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13474 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13475 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13476 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13477 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13478 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13479 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013480 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13481 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13482 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013483 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13484 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13485 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13486 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13487 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013488
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013489 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13490 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13491 the corresponding match text.
13492
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013493 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13494 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13495 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13496 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13497 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013498
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013499 Example :
13500
13501 # this is a comment and is ignored
13502 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13503 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13504 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13505 | | | `---------- value
13506 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13507 | `---------------------------- key
13508 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13509
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013510mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013511 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13512 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013513 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013514 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013515 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013516 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13517 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13518 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13519 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013520 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013521 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013522
13523mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013524 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013525 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13526 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013527 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013528 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013529 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013530 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13531 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13532 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13533 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013534 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013535 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013536
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013537nbsrv
13538 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13539 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13540 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13541 map lookup.
13542
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013543neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013544 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13545 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13546 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13547 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013548
13549not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013550 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013551 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013552 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013553 absence of a flag).
13554
13555odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013556 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013557 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13558
13559or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013560 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013561 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013562 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13563 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013564 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013565 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13566 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13567 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13568 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013569 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013570 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013571
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013572regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013573 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13574 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13575 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13576 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13577 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13578 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13579 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13580 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13581 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13582 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013583 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13584 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13585 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13586 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013587
13588 Example :
13589
13590 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13591 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13592 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13593 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13594
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013595capture-req(<id>)
13596 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13597 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13598
13599 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013600 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13601 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013602
13603capture-res(<id>)
13604 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13605 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13606
13607 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013608 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13609 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013610
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013611sdbm([<avalanche>])
13612 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13613 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13614 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13615 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13616 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13617 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13618 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013619 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13620 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013621
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013622set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013623 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13624 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13625 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013626 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013627 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13628 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013629 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013630 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13631 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013632 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013633 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013634
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013635sha1
13636 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13637 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13638
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013639strcmp(<var>)
13640 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13641 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13642 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13643 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13644 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13645 shorter).
13646
13647 Example :
13648
13649 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13650 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13651 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13652
13653
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013654sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013655 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13656 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013657 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013658 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13659 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013660 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013661 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13662 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013663 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013664 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13665 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013666 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013667 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013668
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013669table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13670 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13671 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13672 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13673 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13674 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13675 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13676
13677
13678table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13679 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13680 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13681 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13682 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13683 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13684 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13685
13686table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13687 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13688 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013689 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013690 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13691 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13692
13693table_conn_cur(<table>)
13694 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13695 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13696 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13697 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13698 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13699
13700table_conn_rate(<table>)
13701 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13702 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13703 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13704 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13705 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13706
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013707table_gpt0(<table>)
13708 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13709 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13710 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13711 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13712 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13713
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013714table_gpc0(<table>)
13715 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13716 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13717 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13718 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13719 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13720
13721table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13722 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13723 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13724 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13725 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13726 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13727 sample fetch keyword.
13728
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013729table_gpc1(<table>)
13730 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13731 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13732 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13733 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13734 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13735
13736table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13737 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13738 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13739 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13740 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13741 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13742 sample fetch keyword.
13743
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013744table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13745 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13746 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013747 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013748 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13749 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13750
13751table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13752 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13753 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13754 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13755 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13756 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13757 keyword.
13758
13759table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13760 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13761 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013762 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013763 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13764 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13765
13766table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13767 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13768 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13769 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13770 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13771 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13772 keyword.
13773
13774table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13775 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13776 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013777 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013778 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13779 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13780 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13781 keyword.
13782
13783table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13784 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13785 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013786 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013787 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13788 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13789 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13790 keyword.
13791
13792table_server_id(<table>)
13793 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13794 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13795 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13796 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13797 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13798 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13799
13800table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13801 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13802 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013803 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013804 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13805 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13806 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13807 keyword.
13808
13809table_sess_rate(<table>)
13810 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13811 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13812 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13813 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13814 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13815 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13816 keyword.
13817
13818table_trackers(<table>)
13819 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13820 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13821 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13822 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13823 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13824 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13825 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13826 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13827 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13828 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13829
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013830upper
13831 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13832 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13833 type. The result is of type string.
13834
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013835url_dec
13836 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13837 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13838
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013839unset-var(<var name>)
13840 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13841 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13842 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13843 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13844 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13845 response),
13846 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13847 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13848 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13849 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13850
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013851utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13852 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13853 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13854 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13855 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13856 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13857 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13858
13859 Example :
13860
13861 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013862 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013863 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13864
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013865word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13866 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13867 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13868 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13869 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13870 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13871
13872 Example :
13873 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13874 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13875 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13876 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13877 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013878
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013879wt6([<avalanche>])
13880 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13881 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13882 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13883 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13884 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13885 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13886 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013887 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13888 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013889
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013890xor(<value>)
13891 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013892 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013893 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013894 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013895 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013896 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13897 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013898 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013899 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13900 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013901 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013902 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013903
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013904xxh32([<seed>])
13905 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13906 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13907 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13908 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13909 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13910 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13911 as cryptographically secure.
13912
13913xxh64([<seed>])
13914 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13915 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13916 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13917 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13918 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13919 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13920 as cryptographically secure.
13921
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013922
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139237.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013924--------------------------------------------
13925
13926A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13927not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13928"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13929The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13930
13931always_false : boolean
13932 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13933 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13934
13935always_true : boolean
13936 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13937 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13938
13939avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013940 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013941 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13942 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13943 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13944 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13945 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13946 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13947 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13948 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13949 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13950 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13951 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13952 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13953 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013955be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013956 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13957 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13958 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13959 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013960 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
13961
13962be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
13963 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13964 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
13965 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
13966 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
13967 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013968 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
13969 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013970
13971 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
13972 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
13973 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013975be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13976 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13977 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13978 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013979 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013980 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13981 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013982
13983 Example :
13984 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13985 backend dynamic
13986 mode http
13987 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13988 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013989
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013990bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013991 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13992 of the string.
13993
13994bool(<bool>) : bool
13995 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13996 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013998connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13999 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014000 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014001 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14002 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014003
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014004 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014005 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014006 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14007
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014008 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14009 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014010
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014011 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014012 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014013 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014014 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014015 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014016 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014017 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014018
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014019 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14020 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014021 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014022 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014023
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014024cpu_calls : integer
14025 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14026 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14027 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14028 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14029 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14030 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14031
14032cpu_ns_avg : integer
14033 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14034 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14035 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14036 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14037 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14038 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14039 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14040 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14041 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14042 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14043 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14044
14045cpu_ns_tot : integer
14046 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14047 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14048 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14049 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14050 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14051 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14052 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14053 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14054 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14055 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14056 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14057 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14058 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14059
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014060date([<offset>]) : integer
14061 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14062 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14063 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14064 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014065 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14066
14067 Example :
14068
14069 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14070 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014071
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014072date_us : integer
14073 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14074 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14075 from the same timeval structure.
14076
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014077distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14078 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14079 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14080 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14081 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14082 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14083 list of supported tokens.
14084
14085distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14086 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14087 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14088 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14089 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14090 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14091 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14092 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14093 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14094 supported tokens.
14095
14096 Example :
14097 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14098 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14099 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14100 # send large files to the big farm
14101 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14102
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014103env(<name>) : string
14104 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14105 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14106 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14107 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14108 certain way.
14109
14110 Examples :
14111 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14112 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14113
14114 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14115 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014117fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14118 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014119 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14120 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014121 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14122 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014123 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014124 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14125 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014126
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014127fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14128 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14129 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14130 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014132fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14133 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14134 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14135 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14136 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14137 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14138 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14139 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14140 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014141
14142 Example :
14143 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14144 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14145 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14146 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14147 frontend mail
14148 bind :25
14149 mode tcp
14150 maxconn 100
14151 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14152 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14153 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14154 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014155
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014156hostname : string
14157 Returns the system hostname.
14158
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014159int(<integer>) : signed integer
14160 Returns a signed integer.
14161
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014162ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14163 Returns an ipv4.
14164
14165ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14166 Returns an ipv6.
14167
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014168lat_ns_avg : integer
14169 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14170 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14171 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14172 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14173 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14174 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14175 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14176 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14177 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14178 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14179 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14180 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14181 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14182 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14183
14184lat_ns_tot : integer
14185 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14186 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14187 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14188 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14189 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14190 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14191 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14192 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14193 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14194 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14195 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14196 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14197 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14198 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14199 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14200 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14201 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14202 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14203 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14204
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014205meth(<method>) : method
14206 Returns a method.
14207
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014208nbproc : integer
14209 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14210 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14211 and debugging purposes.
14212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014213nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14214 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14215 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14216 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014217 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14218 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14219 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014220
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014221prio_class : integer
14222 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14223 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14224 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14225
14226prio_offset : integer
14227 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14228 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14229 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14230 set-priority-offset".
14231
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014232proc : integer
14233 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14234 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14235 debugging purposes.
14236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014237queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014238 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14239 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14240 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014241 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14242 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14243 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14244 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14245 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14246
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014247rand([<range>]) : integer
14248 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14249 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14250 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14251 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14252 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14255 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14256 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14257 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14258 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14259 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014260 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14261 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14262
14263srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14264 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14265 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14266 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14267 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14268 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14269 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14270 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14271
14272 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14273 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014274
14275srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14276 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14277 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14278 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014279 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014280 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14281 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14282 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14283
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014284srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14285 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14286 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14287 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14288 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14289 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14290 fetch methods.
14291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014292srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14293 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14294 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014295 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014296 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14297 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014298 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014299 overloading servers).
14300
14301 Example :
14302 # Redirect to a separate back
14303 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14304 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14305 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14306
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014307stopping : boolean
14308 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14309 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14310 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14311
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014312str(<string>) : string
14313 Returns a string.
14314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014315table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14316 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14317 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14318
14319table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14320 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14321 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14322 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14323
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014324thread : integer
14325 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14326 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14327 and debugging purposes.
14328
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014329var(<var-name>) : undefined
14330 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014331 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14332 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014333 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014334 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14335 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014336 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014337 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14338 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014339 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014340 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014341
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143427.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014343----------------------------------
14344
14345The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14346closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14347methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14348sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14349TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014350the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14351counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014352"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14353used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14354can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14355Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14356table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14357tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14358currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014359
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014360bc_http_major: integer
14361 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14362 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14363 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014365be_id : integer
14366 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14367 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14368
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014369be_name : string
14370 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14371 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014373dst : ip
14374 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14375 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14376 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14377 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
14378 RFC 4291.
14379
14380dst_conn : integer
14381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14382 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14383 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14384 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14385 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14386 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14387 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14388 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014389
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014390dst_is_local : boolean
14391 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14392 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14393 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14394 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014395 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014396 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14397 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14398 it only once per connection.
14399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014400dst_port : integer
14401 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14402 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14403 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14404 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14405 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14406 an HTTP header.
14407
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014408fc_http_major : integer
14409 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14410 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14411 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14412
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014413fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14414 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14415 header.
14416
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014417fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14418 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14419 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14420 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14421 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14422 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14423 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14424
14425fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14426 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14427 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14428 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14429 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14430 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14431 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14432
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014433fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14434 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14435 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14436 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14437 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14438
14439fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14440 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14441 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14442 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14443 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14444
14445fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14446 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14447 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14448 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14449 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14450
14451fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14452 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14453 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14454 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14455 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14456
14457fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14458 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14459 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14460 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14461 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14462
14463fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14464 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14465 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14466 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14467 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14468
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014469fe_defbe : string
14470 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14471 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014473fe_id : integer
14474 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014475 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14477
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014478fe_name : string
14479 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14480 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14481 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14482
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014483sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014484sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14485sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14486sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014487 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14488 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14489 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14490
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014491sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014492sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14493sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14494sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014495 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14496 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14497 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014499sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014500sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14501sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14502sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014503 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14504 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014505 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14506 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14507 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014508
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014509 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014510 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14511 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014512 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14513 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14514 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014515 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14516 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14517
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014518sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14519sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14520sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14521sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14522 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14523 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14524 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14525 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14526 when a first ACL was verified.
14527
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014528sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014529sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14530sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14531sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014532 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014533 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14534
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014535sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014536sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14537sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14538sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014539 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14540 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14541 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14542
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014543sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014544sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14545sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14546sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014547 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14548 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14549 See also src_conn_rate.
14550
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014551sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014552sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14553sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14554sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014555 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014556 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014557
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014558sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14559sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14560sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14561sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14562 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14563 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14564
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014565sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14566sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14567sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14568sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14569 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14570 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14571
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014572sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014573sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14574sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14575sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014576 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14577 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14578 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014579 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14580 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14581 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014582
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014583sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14584sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14585sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14586sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14587 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14588 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14589 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14590 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14591 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14592 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14593
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014594sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014595sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14596sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14597sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014598 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014599 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14600 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14601
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014602sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014603sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14604sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14605sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014606 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14607 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14608 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14609 src_http_err_rate.
14610
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014611sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014612sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14613sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14614sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014615 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014616 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14617 src_http_req_cnt.
14618
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014619sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014620sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14621sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14622sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014623 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14624 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14625 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14626 src_http_req_rate.
14627
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014628sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014629sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14630sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14631sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014632 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014633 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14634 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14635 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14636 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014637
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014638 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014639 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14640 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014641 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14642
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014643sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14644sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14645sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14646sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14647 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14648 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14649 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14650 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14651 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14652
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014653sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014654sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14655sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14656sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014657 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14658 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14659 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014660
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014661sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014662sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14663sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14664sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014665 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14666 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14667 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014669sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014670sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14671sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14672sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014673 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014674 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14675 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14676 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014677 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014678 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14679
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014680sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014681sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14682sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14683sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014684 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14685 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14686 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14687 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14688 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014689 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014690
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014691sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014692sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14693sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14694sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014695 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14696 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14697 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14698
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014699sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014700sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14701sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14702sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014703 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14704 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014705 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014706 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14707 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014708 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14709 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14710 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712so_id : integer
14713 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14714 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14715 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014717src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014718 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014719 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14720 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14721 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014722 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14723 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14724 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
14725 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014726
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014727 Example:
14728 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14729 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014731src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14732 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14733 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14734 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014735 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014737src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14738 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14739 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014740 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014741 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014743src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14744 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14745 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14746 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14747 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14748 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14749 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014750
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014751 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014752 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14753 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14754 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14755 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014756 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014757 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14758 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14759
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014760src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14761 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14762 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14763 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14764 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14765 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14766 was verified.
14767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014769 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014770 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014771 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014772 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014774src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014775 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014776 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14777 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014778 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014780src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14781 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14782 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14783 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014784 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014786src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014787 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014789 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014790 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014791
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014792src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14793 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14794 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14795 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14796 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14797
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014798src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14799 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14800 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14801 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14802 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014805 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014806 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014807 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14808 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014809 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14810 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14811 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014812
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014813src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14814 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14815 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14816 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14817 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14818 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14819 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14820 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014823 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014825 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014826 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014829src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14830 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14831 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14832 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14833 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014834 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014836src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014837 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014838 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14839 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014840 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014842src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14843 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14844 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14845 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014846 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014847 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014849src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14850 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14851 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14852 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014853 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14855 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014856
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014857 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014858 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014859 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014860 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014861
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014862src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14863 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14864 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14865 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14866 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14867 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14868 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14869
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014870src_is_local : boolean
14871 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14872 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14873 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14874 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014875 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014876 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14877 once per connection.
14878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014879src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014880 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14881 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14882 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14883 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14884 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014887 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14888 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14889 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14890 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14891 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893src_port : integer
14894 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14895 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14896 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14897 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014899src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014900 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014901 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14902 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14903 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014904 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014906src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14907 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14908 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14909 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14910 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014911 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014913src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14914 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14915 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14916 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14917 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14918 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14919 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14920 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14921 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014922
14923 Example :
14924 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14925 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14926 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14927 listen ssh
14928 bind :22
14929 mode tcp
14930 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014931 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014933 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014935srv_id : integer
14936 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14937 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14938 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014939
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200149407.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014941----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014943The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14944closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14945when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14946usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014947future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014948
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001494951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14950 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14951 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14952 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14953 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14954 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14955
14956 Example :
14957 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14958 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14959 # the request.
14960 frontend http-in
14961 bind *:8081
14962 default_backend servers
14963 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14964 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14965
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014966ssl_bc : boolean
14967 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14968 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14969 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14970
14971ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14972 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14973 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14974
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010014975ssl_bc_alpn : string
14976 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
14977 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
14978 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
14979 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14980 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14981 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
14982 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
14983 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14984 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
14985
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014986ssl_bc_cipher : string
14987 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14988 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14989
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010014990ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
14991 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14992 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
14993 session or a TLS ticket.
14994
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010014995ssl_bc_npn : string
14996 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
14997 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
14998 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
14999 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15000 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15001 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15002 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15003 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15004
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015005ssl_bc_protocol : string
15006 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15007 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15008
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015009ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015010 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015011 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15012 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015013
15014ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15015 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15016 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15017 if session was reused or not.
15018
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015019ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15020 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15021 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15022 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15023 BoringSSL.
15024
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015025ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15026 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15027 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015029ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15030 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15031 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15032 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15033 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15034 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015036ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15037 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15038 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15039 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15040 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015041
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015042ssl_c_der : binary
15043 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15044 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15045 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015047ssl_c_err : integer
15048 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15049 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15050 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15051 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15052 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015054ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15055 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15056 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15057 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15058 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15059 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15060 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15061 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15062 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015064ssl_c_key_alg : string
15065 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15066 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15067 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015069ssl_c_notafter : string
15070 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15071 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15072 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074ssl_c_notbefore : string
15075 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15076 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15077 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015079ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15080 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15081 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15082 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15083 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15084 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15085 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15086 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15087 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015089ssl_c_serial : binary
15090 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15091 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15092 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015094ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15095 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15096 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15097 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015098 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15099 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15100
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015101 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015102 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15105 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15106 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15107 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015109ssl_c_used : boolean
15110 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15111 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015113ssl_c_verify : integer
15114 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15115 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15116 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15117 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015119ssl_c_version : integer
15120 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15121 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015122
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015123ssl_f_der : binary
15124 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15125 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15126 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15129 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15130 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15131 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15132 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015133 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015134 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15135 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15136 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015138ssl_f_key_alg : string
15139 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15140 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15141 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015143ssl_f_notafter : string
15144 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15145 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15146 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015148ssl_f_notbefore : string
15149 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15150 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15151 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15154 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15155 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15156 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15157 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15158 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15159 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15160 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15161 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015163ssl_f_serial : binary
15164 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15165 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15166 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015167
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015168ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15169 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15170 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15171 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15174 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15175 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15176 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015178ssl_f_version : integer
15179 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15180 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15181
15182ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015183 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15184 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15185 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187 Example :
15188 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15189 listen http-https
15190 bind :80
15191 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15192 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15193
15194ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15195 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15196 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15197
15198ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015199 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15201 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15202 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15203 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15204 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15205 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15206 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15207 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209ssl_fc_cipher : string
15210 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15211 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015212
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015213ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15214 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15215 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015216 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015217
15218ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15219 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15220 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015221 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015222
15223ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15224 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15225 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15226 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015227 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015228 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015229
15230ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15231 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15232 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015233 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015235ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015236 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15237 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015238 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15239 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15240 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15241 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015242
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015243ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15244 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15245 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15246 wait until the handshake happened.
15247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15249 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015250 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15251 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15252 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15253 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015254
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015255ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015256 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015257 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15258 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015260ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015261 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015262 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15263 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15264 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15265 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15266 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15267 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15268 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015270ssl_fc_protocol : string
15271 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15272 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015273
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015274ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015275 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015276 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15277 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15280 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15281 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15282 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15283 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015284
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015285ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15286 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15287 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15288 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15289 BoringSSL.
15290
15291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015292ssl_fc_sni : string
15293 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15294 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15295 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15296 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15297 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15298
15299 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15300 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15301 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015302 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15303 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015305 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015306 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15307 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15310 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15311 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015312
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015313
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153147.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015315------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015317Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15318sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15319only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15320For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15321be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15322can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15323sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15324for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15325content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015328 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015329 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15330 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15333 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015334 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015335 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015336
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015337req.hdrs : string
15338 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15339 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15340 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15341 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15342
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015343req.hdrs_bin : binary
15344 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15345 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15346 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15347 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15348 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15349 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15350
15351 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15352
15353 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15354 str: <int:length><bytes>
15355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015356req.len : integer
15357req_len : integer (deprecated)
15358 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15359 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15360 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15361 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15362 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15363 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15364 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15365 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015367req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15368 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015369 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15370 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15371 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15372 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015374 ACL alternatives :
15375 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015377req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15378 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15379 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15380 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15381 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015383 ACL alternatives :
15384 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015386 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388req.proto_http : boolean
15389req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15390 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15391 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15392 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15393 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15394 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15395 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15396 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015398 Example:
15399 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15400 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15401 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015402 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015404req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15405rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15406 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15407 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15408 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15409 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15410 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15411 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15412 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015414 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15415 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15416 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15417 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15418 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15419 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015421 ACL derivatives :
15422 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015424 Example :
15425 listen tse-farm
15426 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15427 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15428 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15429 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15430 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15431 persist rdp-cookie
15432 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15433 # This is only useful makes sense if
15434 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15435 stick-table type string size 204800
15436 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15437 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15438 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015440 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15441 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15444rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15445 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15446 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15447 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15448 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015450 ACL derivatives :
15451 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015452
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015453req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15454 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15455 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015456 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15457 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15458 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15459 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15460 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15463req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15464 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15465 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15466 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15467 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15468 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15469 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15470 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472req.ssl_sni : string
15473req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15474 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15475 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15476 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15477 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15478 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15479 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15480 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15481 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15482 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15483 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15484 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15485 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015487 ACL derivatives :
15488 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490 Examples :
15491 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15492 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15493 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15494 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15495 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015496
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015497req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15498 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15499 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15500 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15501 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15502 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15503 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15504 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15505 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15506 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508req.ssl_ver : integer
15509req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15510 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15511 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15512 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15513 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15514 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15515 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15516 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015517 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520 ACL derivatives :
15521 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015522
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015523res.len : integer
15524 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15525 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15526 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15527 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15528 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15529 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15530 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15531 content inspection.
15532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015533res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15534 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015535 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15536 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15537 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15538 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15541 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15542 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15543 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15544 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015547
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015548res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15549rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15550 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15551 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15552 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15553 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15554 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15555 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15556 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558wait_end : boolean
15559 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15560 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015561 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15563 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015564 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015565 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15566 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015568 Examples :
15569 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15570 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15571 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15574 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15575 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15576 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15577 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15578 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15579 tcp-request content reject
15580
15581
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583--------------------------------------
15584
15585It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15586This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15587data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15588its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15589HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15590content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15591to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15592more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15593response are indexed.
15594
15595base : string
15596 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15597 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15598 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15599 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15600 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15601 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15602 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15603 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15604
15605 ACL derivatives :
15606 base : exact string match
15607 base_beg : prefix match
15608 base_dir : subdir match
15609 base_dom : domain match
15610 base_end : suffix match
15611 base_len : length match
15612 base_reg : regex match
15613 base_sub : substring match
15614
15615base32 : integer
15616 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15617 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15618 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015619 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15620 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15621 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622
15623base32+src : binary
15624 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15625 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15626 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15627 per-URL counters.
15628
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015629capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15630 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15631 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15632 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15633
15634capture.req.method : string
15635 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15636 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15637 because it's allocated.
15638
15639capture.req.uri : string
15640 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15641 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15642 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15643 allocated.
15644
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015645capture.req.ver : string
15646 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15647 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15648 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15649
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015650capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15651 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15652 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15653 The first entry is an index of 0.
15654 See also: "capture response header"
15655
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015656capture.res.ver : string
15657 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15658 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15659 persistent flag.
15660
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015661req.body : binary
15662 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15663 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15664 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15665 the first chunk is analyzed.
15666
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015667req.body_param([<name>) : string
15668 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15669 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15670 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15671 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15672 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15673 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15674 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15675 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15676 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15677 given.
15678
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015679req.body_len : integer
15680 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15681 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15682 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15683 "option http-buffer-request".
15684
15685req.body_size : integer
15686 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15687 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15688 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15689 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15690 "option http-buffer-request".
15691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692req.cook([<name>]) : string
15693cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15694 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15695 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15696 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15697 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15698 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15699 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15700 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15701 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15702
15703 ACL derivatives :
15704 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15705 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15706 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15707 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15708 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15709 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15710 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15711 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15714cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15715 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15716 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15719cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15720 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15721 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15722 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15723 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15726 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15727 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15728 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15729 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015730 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15732 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15733 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15734 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15737 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15738 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15739 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15740 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015741 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15744 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15745 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15746 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15747 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15748 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15749 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15750 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15751 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15754 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15755 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15756 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15757 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15760 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15761 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15762 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15763 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15764 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15765 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15766 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15767 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015768 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015770 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015772 ACL derivatives :
15773 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15774 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15775 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15776 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15777 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15778 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15779 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15780 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15781
15782req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15783hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15784 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15785 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15786 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15787 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15788 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15789 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15790 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15791 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15792 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15793
15794req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15795hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15796 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15797 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15798 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15799 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15800 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015801 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015802 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15803 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15804
15805req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15806hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15807 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15808 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15809 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15810 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15811 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15812 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15813 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15814
15815http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15816 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15817 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15818 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15819 basic auth is supported.
15820
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015821http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15822 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15823 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15824 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15825 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015826 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15827 basic auth is supported.
15828
15829 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015830 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15831 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15832 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15833 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834
15835http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015836 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15837 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015838 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15839 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015841method : integer + string
15842 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15843 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15844 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15845 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15846 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15847 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15848 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015850 ACL derivatives :
15851 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015853 Example :
15854 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15855 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15856 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015858path : string
15859 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15860 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15861 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15862 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15863 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015864 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867 ACL derivatives :
15868 path : exact string match
15869 path_beg : prefix match
15870 path_dir : subdir match
15871 path_dom : domain match
15872 path_end : suffix match
15873 path_len : length match
15874 path_reg : regex match
15875 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015876
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015877query : string
15878 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15879 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15880 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15881 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015882 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015883 which stops before the question mark.
15884
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015885req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15886 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15887 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15888 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15889 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891req.ver : string
15892req_ver : string (deprecated)
15893 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15894 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15895 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015897 ACL derivatives :
15898 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900res.comp : boolean
15901 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15902 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15903 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905res.comp_algo : string
15906 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15907 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15908 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910res.cook([<name>]) : string
15911scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15912 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15913 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15914 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916 ACL derivatives :
15917 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015919res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15920scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15921 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15922 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15923 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15926scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15927 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15928 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15929 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015931res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15932 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15933 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15934 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15935 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15936 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15937 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15938 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15939 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15940 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15943 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15944 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15945 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15946 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15947 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15950shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15951 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15952 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15953 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15954 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15955 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15956 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15957 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15958 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960 ACL derivatives :
15961 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15962 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15963 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15964 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15965 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15966 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15967 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15968 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15969
15970res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15971shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15972 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15973 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15974 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15975 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15976 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15979shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15980 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15981 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15982 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15983 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15984 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15985 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015986
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015987res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15988 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15989 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15990 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15991 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015993res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15994shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15995 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15996 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15997 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15998 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15999 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16000 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002res.ver : string
16003resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16004 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16005 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007 ACL derivatives :
16008 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016010set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16011 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16012 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016013 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16017 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016019status : integer
16020 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16021 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16022 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016023
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016024unique-id : string
16025 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16026 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16027 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16028 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16029 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16030 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016032url : string
16033 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16034 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16035 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16036 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16037 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16038 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16039 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041 ACL derivatives :
16042 url : exact string match
16043 url_beg : prefix match
16044 url_dir : subdir match
16045 url_dom : domain match
16046 url_end : suffix match
16047 url_len : length match
16048 url_reg : regex match
16049 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016051url_ip : ip
16052 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16053 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16054 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16055 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16056 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16057 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16058 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016060url_port : integer
16061 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16062 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16063 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16064 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016065
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016066urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16067url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016068 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16069 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016070 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16071 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16072 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16073 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16075 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016076 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16077 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016079 ACL derivatives :
16080 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16081 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16082 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16083 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16084 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16085 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16086 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16087 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016088
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090 Example :
16091 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16092 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16093 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16094 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016095
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016096urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16098 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16099 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016100
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016101url32 : integer
16102 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16103 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16104 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16105 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16106 is an unsigned integer.
16107
16108url32+src : binary
16109 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16110 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16111 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16112
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200161147.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016115---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016117Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16118every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016119order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016121ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16122---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016123FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016124HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016125HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16126HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016127HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16128HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16129HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16130HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16131LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016132METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016133METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016134METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16135METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16136METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16137METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016138METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016139METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016140RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016141REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016142TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016143WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16144---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016145
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161478. Logging
16148----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016149
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016150One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16151provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16152very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16153provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16154state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016155to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016156headers.
16157
16158In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16159about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16160send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16161
16162 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16163 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16164 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16165 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16166 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016167 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016168 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016169
16170The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16171allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16172as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16173while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16174real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16175delay.
16176
16177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161788.1. Log levels
16179---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016180
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016181TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016182source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016183HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16184in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16185track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16186syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16187about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016188
16189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161908.2. Log formats
16191----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016192
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016193HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016194and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16195slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16196options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016197
16198 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16199 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16200 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16201 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16202 extents.
16203
16204 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16205 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16206 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16207 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16208 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16209
16210 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16211 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16212 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16213 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16214 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16215
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016216 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16217 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16218 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16219 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16220
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016221 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016223Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16224specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16225field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16226servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16227always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16228identifier.
16229
16230Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16231 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16232 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16233 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16234 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16235
16236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162378.2.1. Default log format
16238-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016239
16240This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16241as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16242format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16243
16244 Example :
16245 listen www
16246 mode http
16247 log global
16248 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16249
16250 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16251 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16252 (www/HTTP)
16253
16254 Field Format Extract from the example above
16255 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16256 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16257 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16258 4 'to' to
16259 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16260 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16261
16262Detailed fields description :
16263 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16264 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16265 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16266 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16267 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16268 and processed the connection.
16269 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16270
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016271In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16272"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16273connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16274
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016275It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16276will eventually disappear.
16277
16278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162798.2.2. TCP log format
16280---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016281
16282The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16283is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16284information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16285counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16286emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16287environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16288the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16289sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016290specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16291not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16292fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16293marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016294
16295 Example :
16296 frontend fnt
16297 mode tcp
16298 option tcplog
16299 log global
16300 default_backend bck
16301
16302 backend bck
16303 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16304
16305 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16306 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16307 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16308
16309 Field Format Extract from the example above
16310 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16311 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16312 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16313 4 frontend_name fnt
16314 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16315 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16316 7 bytes_read* 212
16317 8 termination_state --
16318 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16319 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16320
16321Detailed fields description :
16322 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016323 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16324 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16325 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016326 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016327 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016328 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016329
16330 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016331 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16332 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16333 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016334
16335 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16336 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16337 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016338 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16339 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16340 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16341 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016342
16343 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16344 and processed the connection.
16345
16346 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16347 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16348 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16349 applications.
16350
16351 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16352 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16353 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16354 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16355 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16356
16357 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16358 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16359 See "Timers" below for more details.
16360
16361 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16362 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16363 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16364 "Timers" below for more details.
16365
16366 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016367 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016368 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16369 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16370 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16371 details.
16372
16373 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16374 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16375 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16376 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16377 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16378
16379 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16380 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16381 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16382 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16383 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16384 for more details.
16385
16386 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016387 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016388 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16389 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16390 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016391 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016392
16393 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16394 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16395 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16396 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16397 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16398 caused by a denial of service attack.
16399
16400 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16401 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16402 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16403 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16404 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16405 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16406 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16407 denial of service attack.
16408
16409 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16410 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16411 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16412 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16413 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16414 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16415 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16416 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16417 be processed than on other servers.
16418
16419 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16420 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16421 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16422 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16423 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16424 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16425 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16426 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16427 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16428 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16429 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16430 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16431 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16432
16433 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16434 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16435 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16436 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16437 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16438 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016439 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016440 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16441
16442 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16443 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16444 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16445 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16446 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16447 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016448 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016449 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16450 occurs.
16451
16452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164538.2.3. HTTP log format
16454----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016455
16456The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16457is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16458the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16459are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16460emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16461generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16462"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16463which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016464frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16465is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016466
16467Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16468slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16469with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16470
16471 Example :
16472 frontend http-in
16473 mode http
16474 option httplog
16475 log global
16476 default_backend bck
16477
16478 backend static
16479 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16480
16481 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16482 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16483 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016484 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016485
16486 Field Format Extract from the example above
16487 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16488 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016489 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016490 4 frontend_name http-in
16491 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016492 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016493 7 status_code 200
16494 8 bytes_read* 2750
16495 9 captured_request_cookie -
16496 10 captured_response_cookie -
16497 11 termination_state ----
16498 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16499 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16500 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16501 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16502 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016503
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016504Detailed fields description :
16505 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016506 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16507 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16508 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016509 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016510 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016511 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016512
16513 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016514 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16515 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16516 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016517
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016518 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16519 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016520
16521 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16522 and processed the connection.
16523
16524 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16525 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16526 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16527
16528 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16529 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16530 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16531 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16532 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16533 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16534
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016535 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16536 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16537 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16538 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16539 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16540 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016541 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16542 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016543
16544 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16545 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016546 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016547
16548 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16549 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016550 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16551 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016552
16553 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16554 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16555 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16556 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16557 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016558 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16559 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016560
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016561 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16562 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16563 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16564 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16565 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16566 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16567 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016568 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016569
16570 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16571 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16572 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16573
16574 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16575 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16576 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16577 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16578 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16579 overflowing.
16580
16581 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16582 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16583 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16584 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16585 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16586 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16587 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16588 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16589
16590 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16591 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16592 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16593 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16594 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16595 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16596 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16597 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16598
16599 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16600 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16601 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16602 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16603 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16604 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16605 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16606
16607 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016608 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016609 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16610 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16611 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016612 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016613 system.
16614
16615 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16616 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16617 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16618 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16619 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16620 caused by a denial of service attack.
16621
16622 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16623 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16624 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16625 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16626 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16627 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16628 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16629 denial of service attack.
16630
16631 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16632 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16633 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16634 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16635 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16636 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16637 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16638 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16639 processed than on other servers.
16640
16641 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16642 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16643 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16644 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16645 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16646 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16647 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16648 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16649 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16650 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16651 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16652 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16653 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16654
16655 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16656 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16657 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16658 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16659 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16660 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016661 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016662 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16663
16664 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16665 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16666 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16667 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16668 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16669 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016670 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016671 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16672 occurs.
16673
16674 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16675 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16676 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16677 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16678 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16679 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16680 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16681 cookies" below for more details.
16682
16683 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16684 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16685 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16686 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16687 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16688 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16689 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16690 and cookies" below for more details.
16691
16692 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16693 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16694 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16695 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16696 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16697 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16698 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16699 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16700
16701
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200167028.2.4. Custom log format
16703------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016704
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016705The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016706mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016707
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016708HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016709Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16710separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16711prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16712
16713Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16714variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016715("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016716
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016717If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016718as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016719less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16720the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16721
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016722Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016723In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016724in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016725
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016726Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16727'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16728https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16729such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16730
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016731Flags are :
16732 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016733 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016734 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16735 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016736
16737 Example:
16738
16739 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16740 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16741
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016742 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16743
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016744At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16745
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016746 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16747 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016748
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016749the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016750
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016751 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16752 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16753 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016754
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016755and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16756
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016757 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16758 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016759
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016760Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16761
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016762 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016763 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016764 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16765 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16766 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016767 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16768 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16769 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016770 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016771 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16772 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016773 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016774 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16775 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016776 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016777 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016778 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016779 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016780 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016781 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016782 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016783 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16784 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16785 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16786 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16787 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016788 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016789 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16790 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016791 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016792 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16793 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016794 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16795 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16796 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016797 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016798 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16799 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016800 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016801 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16802 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16803 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016804 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016805 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016806 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16807 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16808 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16809 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016810 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016811 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016812 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016813 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016814 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016815 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016816 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16817 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16818 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016819 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016820 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16821 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016822 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016823 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16824 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016825 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016826 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016827 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016828 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016829
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016830 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016831
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016832
168338.2.5. Error log format
16834-----------------------
16835
16836When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16837protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16838By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16839"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016840will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016841logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16842
16843The format looks like this :
16844
16845 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16846 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16847 Connection error during SSL handshake
16848
16849 Field Format Extract from the example above
16850 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16851 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16852 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16853 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16854 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16855
16856These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16857failures.
16858
16859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168608.3. Advanced logging options
16861-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016862
16863Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16864just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16865options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16866for more information about their usage.
16867
16868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168698.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16870------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016871
16872It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16873haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16874commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16875monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16876ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16877
16878 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16879 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16880 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16881 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16882
16883 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16884 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16885 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016886 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016887 such as other load-balancers.
16888
16889 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16890 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16891 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16892
16893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168948.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16895----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016896
16897The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16898what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16899or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016900"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016901just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16902log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16903after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16904is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16905with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16906with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16907
16908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169098.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16910------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016911
16912Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16913for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16914"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16915retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16916raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16917a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16918file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16919you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16920"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16921
16922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169238.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16924--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016925
16926Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16927multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16928them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16929"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16930logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16931error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16932and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16933too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16934useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16935alternative.
16936
16937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169388.4. Timing events
16939------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016940
16941Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16942reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16943the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16944frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016945mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16946addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16947
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016948Timings events in HTTP mode:
16949
16950 first request 2nd request
16951 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16952 t tr t tr ...
16953 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16954 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16955 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16956 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16957 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16958
16959Timings events in TCP mode:
16960
16961 TCP session
16962 |<----------------->|
16963 t t
16964 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16965 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16966 |<------ Tt ------->|
16967
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016968 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016969 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016970 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16971 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16972 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016973 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016974 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
16975 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
16976 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
16977 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016978
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016979 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16980 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16981 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016982 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
16983 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
16984 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
16985 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
16986 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
16987 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016988
16989 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16990 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16991 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16992 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16993 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16994 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16995 request typed by hand during a test.
16996
16997 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16998 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016999 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017000 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17001 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17002 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17003 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017004
17005 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17006 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17007 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17008 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17009 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17010
17011 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17012 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17013 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17014 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17015 connection never established.
17016
17017 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17018 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17019 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17020 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17021 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17022 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17023 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17024 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17025 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17026 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17027 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17028
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017029 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17030 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17031 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17032 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17033 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17034 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17035
17036 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17037
17038 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17039 "Ta" can never be negative.
17040
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017041 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17042 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017043 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17044 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017045 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017046
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017047 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017048
17049 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017050 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17051 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017052
17053These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17054protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17055that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017056due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17057"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17058that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017059
17060Most common cases :
17061
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017062 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17063 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17064 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17065 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17066 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17067 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17068 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17069 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17070 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17071 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17072 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017073 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017074
17075 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17076 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17077 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17078 of ms on remote networks.
17079
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017080 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17081 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17082 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017083
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017084 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17085 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17086 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17087 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17088 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17089 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17090 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17091 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17092 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017093
17094Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17095
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017096 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017097 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017098 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017099
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017100 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017101 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17102 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17103
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017104 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017105 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17106 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17107 flags.
17108
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017109 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17110 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017111 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17112 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17113 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17114 the client connection was maintained open.
17115
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017116 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017117 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017118 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017119 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17120
17121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171228.5. Session state at disconnection
17123-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017124
17125TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17126"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
171272-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17128each of which has a special meaning :
17129
17130 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17131 session to terminate :
17132
17133 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17134
17135 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17136 server explicitly refused it.
17137
17138 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17139 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17140 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17141 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017142 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017143
17144 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17145 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017146
17147 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17148 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17149 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17150 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17151 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17152
17153 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17154 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17155 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17156 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17157 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17158
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017159 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17160 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17161
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017162 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17163 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17164 backup connections when going up.
17165
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017166 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17167
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017168 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17169 send or receive data.
17170
17171 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17172 send or receive data.
17173
17174 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17175 with nothing left in the buffers.
17176
17177 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17178
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017179 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017180 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17181
17182 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17183 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17184 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17185 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17186 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17187
17188 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17189 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17190
17191 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17192 server (HTTP only).
17193
17194 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17195
17196 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17197 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17198 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17199
17200 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17201 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17202 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17203
17204 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17205
17206 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17207 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17208
17209 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17210 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17211 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17212
17213 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17214 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017215 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17216 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017217
17218 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17219 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17220 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17221 another server.
17222
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017223 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017224 server.
17225
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017226 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17227 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17228 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17229 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17230
17231 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17232 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17233 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17234 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17235
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017236 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17237 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17238 "use-server" rule).
17239
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017240 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17241
17242 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17243 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17244
17245 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17246
17247 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17248 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17249 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17250
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017251 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17252 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017253 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017254 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17255 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17256
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017257 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17258
17259 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17260 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17261
17262 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17263
17264 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17265
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017266The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17267was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017268helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17269starvation, attacks, etc...
17270
17271The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17272alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17273easier finding and understanding.
17274
17275 Flags Reason
17276
17277 -- Normal termination.
17278
17279 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17280 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17281 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17282 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17283
17284 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17285 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17286 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17287 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17288 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17289 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017290
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017291 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17292 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017293 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017294
17295 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17296 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17297 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17298
17299 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17300 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17301 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17302 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17303 the server takes too long to respond.
17304
17305 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17306 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17307 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17308 long a time to respond.
17309
17310 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17311 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17312 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17313 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017314 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17315 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017316
17317 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17318 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17319 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17320 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17321 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017322 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017323 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17324 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17325 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17326 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17327 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17328 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17329 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17330 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017331 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017332 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17333 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17334 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017335
17336 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17337 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017338 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17339 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17340 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17341 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017342
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017343 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17344 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017346 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017347 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17348 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017349 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017350 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17351 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17352
17353 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17354 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17355 503 or 504 here.
17356
17357 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17358 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17359 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17360 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17361 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17362
17363 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17364 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017365 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017366 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17367 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17368
17369 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17370 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17371 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17372 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17373 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17374 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17375 between haproxy and the server.
17376
17377 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17378 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17379 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17380 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17381 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17382 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17383 solution is to fix the application.
17384
17385 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17386 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17387 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17388 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17389 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17390 external attacks.
17391
17392 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17393 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017394 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017395 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17396 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17397
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017398 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17399 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17400 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017401 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017402 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017403
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017404 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17405 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17406 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17407 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017408 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17409 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17410 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17411 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17412 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017413
17414 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17415 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17416 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17417 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17418
17419 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17420 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17421 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17422 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17423
17424 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17425 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17426 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17427 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17428
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017429The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17430persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17431important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17432re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17433
17434 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17435
17436 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17437 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17438 set on a GET request.
17439
17440 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17441 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017442 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017443 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17444
17445 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17446 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17447 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17448
17449 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17450 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17451 already got a cookie.
17452
17453 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17454 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17455 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17456 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17457 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17458
17459 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17460 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17461 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17462
17463 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17464 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17465 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17466
17467 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17468 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17469
17470 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17471 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17472 then advertised in the response.
17473
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174758.6. Non-printable characters
17476-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017477
17478In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17479consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17480converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17481prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17482being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17483escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17484is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17485'}' when logging headers.
17486
17487Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17488issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17489containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17490
17491Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17492the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17493performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17494
17495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17497---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017498
17499Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17500achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017501section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017502cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17503the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17504the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017505locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017506not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17507user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17508a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17509wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17510
17511 Examples :
17512 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17513 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17514
17515 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17516 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17517
17518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175198.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17520---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017521
17522Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17523proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17524the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17525server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17526
17527Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17528response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017529section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017530
17531It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017532time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17533appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017534are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17535and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17536follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17537request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17538in the logs.
17539
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017540As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17541frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17542an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17543
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017544 Example :
17545 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17546 listen proxy-out
17547 mode http
17548 option httplog
17549 option logasap
17550 log global
17551 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17552
17553 # log the name of the virtual server
17554 capture request header Host len 20
17555
17556 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17557 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17558
17559 # log the beginning of the referrer
17560 capture request header Referer len 20
17561
17562 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17563 capture response header Server len 20
17564
17565 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17566 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17567
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017568 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017569 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17570
17571 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17572 capture response header Via len 20
17573
17574 # log the URL location during a redirection
17575 capture response header Location len 20
17576
17577 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17578 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17579 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17580 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17581 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17582
17583 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17584 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17585 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17586 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017587 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017588
17589 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17590 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17591 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17592 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17593 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017594 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017595
17596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175978.9. Examples of logs
17598---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017599
17600These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17601them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17602reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17603
17604 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17605 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17606 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17607
17608 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17609 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17610
17611 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17612 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17613 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17614
17615 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17616 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17617
17618 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17619 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17620 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17621
17622 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017623 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017624 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17625 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17626
17627 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17628 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17629 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17630
17631 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17632 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017633 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017634 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17635 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17636 to return the 502 and not the server.
17637
17638 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017639 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017640
17641 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17642 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17643 Nothing was sent to any server.
17644
17645 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17646 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17647
17648 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17649 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017650 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017651 send a 408 return code to the client.
17652
17653 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17654 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17655
17656 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17657 5 seconds ("c----").
17658
17659 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17660 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017661 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017662
17663 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017664 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017665 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17666 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17667 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17668 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17669 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017670
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017671
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200176729. Supported filters
17673--------------------
17674
17675Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17676accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17677unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17678
17679See also : "filter"
17680
176819.1. Trace
17682----------
17683
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017684filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017685
17686 Arguments:
17687 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17688 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17689
17690 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17691 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17692 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17693 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17694
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017695 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017696 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17697 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17698 amount of the parsed data.
17699
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017700 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017701
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017702This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17703callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17704information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17705filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17706
17707Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17708tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17709a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17710
17711
177129.2. HTTP compression
17713---------------------
17714
17715filter compression
17716
17717The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17718keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
17719when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
17720use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
17721used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
17722filters evaluation order.
17723
17724See also : "compression"
17725
17726
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200177279.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17728--------------------------------------------
17729
17730filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17731
17732 Arguments :
17733
17734 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17735 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17736 parsed.
17737
17738 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17739 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17740 part must be placed in its own scope.
17741
17742The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17743external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017744streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017745exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17746also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17747
17748SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17749the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17750
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017751For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017752"doc/SPOE.txt".
17753
17754Important note:
17755 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17756 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17757
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100177589.4. Cache
17759----------
17760
17761filter cache <name>
17762
17763 Arguments :
17764
17765 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17766
17767The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17768"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17769cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
17770other filter than cache is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to
17771explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when two or more filters are used
17772for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters
17773evaluation order.
17774
17775See also : section 10 about cache.
17776
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001777710. Cache
17778---------
17779
17780HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17781(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17782RAM.
17783
17784The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017785this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017786
17787If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17788independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17789when we try to allocate a new one.
17790
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017791The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017792
17793It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17794"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17795for more details.
17796
17797When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17798replaced by "<CACHE>".
17799
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001780010.1. Limitation
17801----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017802
17803The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17804
17805- If the response is not a 200
17806- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017807- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017808- If the response is not cacheable
17809
17810- If the request is not a GET
17811- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017812- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017813
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017814Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
17815filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
17816can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
17817example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
17818"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017819
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001782010.2. Setup
17821-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017822
17823To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17824the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17825
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001782610.2.1. Cache section
17827---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017828
17829cache <name>
17830 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17831 size of cache is mandatory.
17832
17833total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017834 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017835 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017836
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017837max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017838 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17839 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17840 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017841
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017842max-age <seconds>
17843 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17844 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17845 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17846 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17847 default.
17848
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001784910.2.2. Proxy section
17850---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017851
17852http-request cache-use <name>
17853 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17854 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17855 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17856 after this one.
17857
17858http-response cache-store <name>
17859 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17860 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17861 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17862 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17863
17864
17865Example:
17866
17867 backend bck1
17868 mode http
17869
17870 http-request cache-use foobar
17871 http-response cache-store foobar
17872 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17873
17874 cache foobar
17875 total-max-size 4
17876 max-age 240
17877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017878/*
17879 * Local variables:
17880 * fill-column: 79
17881 * End:
17882 */